blob: 4242e014e97f32349540c7970f224fbf271d210f [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau080347f2021-05-01 08:25:15 +02007 2021/05/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200749In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
750regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
751only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
752
753* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
754
755* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
756 starting at one.
757
758* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
759 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
760 first section.
761
762These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
763if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
764section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
765"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
766proxies.
767
768This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
769logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
770to name some config objects like servers for example.
771
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200772See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200773
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100774
7752.4. Conditional blocks
776-----------------------
777
778It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
779some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
780ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
781configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
782versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
783preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
784text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
785lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
786switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
787are defined to form conditional blocks:
788
789 - .if <condition>
790 - .elif <condition>
791 - .else
792 - .endif
793
794The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
795as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
796matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
797there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
798only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
799".elif" of a block.
800
801Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
802ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
803as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
804
805The conditions are currently limited to:
806
807 - an empty string, always returns "false"
808 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
809 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200810 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
811
812The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
813
814 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
815 exists, regardless of its contents
816
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200817 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
818 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
819
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200820Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100821
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200822 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
823 listen mwcli_px
824 bind :1111
825 ...
826 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100827
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200828 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
829 bind :80
830 .endif
831
832 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
833 bind :443 ssl crt ...
834 .endif
835
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100836Three other directives are provided to report some status:
837
838 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
839 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
840 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
841
842Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
843"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
844fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
845provide advice to the user.
846
847Example:
848
849 .if "${A}"
850 .if "${B}"
851 .notice "A=1, B=1"
852 .elif "${C}"
853 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
854 .elif "${D}"
855 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
856 .else
857 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
858 .endif
859 .else
860 .notice "A=0"
861 .endif
862
863
8642.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200865----------------
866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100867Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100868values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
869otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
870numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
871for every keyword. Supported units are :
872
873 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
874 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
875 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
876 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
877 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
878 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
879
880
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01008812.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200882-------------
883
884 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
885 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
886 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
887 global
888 daemon
889 maxconn 256
890
891 defaults
892 mode http
893 timeout connect 5000ms
894 timeout client 50000ms
895 timeout server 50000ms
896
897 frontend http-in
898 bind *:80
899 default_backend servers
900
901 backend servers
902 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
903
904
905 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
906 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
907 global
908 daemon
909 maxconn 256
910
911 defaults
912 mode http
913 timeout connect 5000ms
914 timeout client 50000ms
915 timeout server 50000ms
916
917 listen http-in
918 bind *:80
919 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
920
921
922Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
923
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100924 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200925
926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009273. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200928--------------------
929
930Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
931are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
932of them have command-line equivalents.
933
934The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
935
936 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200937 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200938 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200939 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200940 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200941 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200942 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200943 - description
944 - deviceatlas-json-file
945 - deviceatlas-log-level
946 - deviceatlas-separator
947 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900948 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200949 - gid
950 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100951 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200952 - h1-case-adjust
953 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100954 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100955 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100956 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200957 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200958 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200959 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100960 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200961 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100962 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100963 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200964 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200966 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200967 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +0100968 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200970 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100971 - presetenv
972 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200973 - uid
974 - ulimit-n
975 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200976 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +0100977 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100978 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200979 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200980 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200981 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200982 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200983 - ssl-default-bind-options
984 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200985 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200986 - ssl-default-server-options
987 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100988 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200989 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100990 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100991 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100992 - 51degrees-data-file
993 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200994 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200995 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200996 - wurfl-data-file
997 - wurfl-information-list
998 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200999 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001000 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001001
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001002 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001003 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001004 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001006 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001007 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001008 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001009 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001010 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001011 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001012 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001013 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001014 - noepoll
1015 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001016 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001017 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001018 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001019 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001020 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001021 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001022 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001023 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001024 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001025 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001026 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001027 - tune.buffers.limit
1028 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001029 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001030 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001031 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001032 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001033 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001034 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001035 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001036 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001037 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001038 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001039 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001040 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001041 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001042 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001043 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1044 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001045 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001046 - tune.maxaccept
1047 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001048 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001049 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001050 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001051 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1052 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001053 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1054 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001055 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001056 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001057 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001058 - tune.sndbuf.client
1059 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001060 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001061 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001062 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001063 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001064 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001065 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001066 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001067 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001068 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001069 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001070 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1071 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1072 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001073 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1074 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001075
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001077 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001078 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001079
1080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010813.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001082------------------------------------
1083
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001084ca-base <dir>
1085 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001086 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1087 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1088 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001089
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090chroot <jail dir>
1091 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1092 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1093 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1094 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1095 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001096 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001097
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001098cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1099 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1100 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1101 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1102 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1103 set. These sets have the format
1104
1105 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1106
1107 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001108 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001109 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1110 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001111 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1112 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001113 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1114 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1115 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1116 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1117 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1118 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1119 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1120 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1121 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1122 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001123
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001124 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1125 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1126 on the machine's word size.
1127
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001128 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001129 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1130 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1131 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1132 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1133 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1134 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001135
1136 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001137 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1138
1139 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1140 # first 4 CPUs
1141
1142 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1143 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1144 # word size.
1145
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001146 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001147 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001148 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1149 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1150 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1151
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001152 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1153 # and so on.
1154 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1155 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1156 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1157
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001158 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001159 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1160 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1161 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1162
1163 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1164 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1165 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1166
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001167 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1168 # and a thread range.
1169 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1170 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1171 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1172
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001173crt-base <dir>
1174 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001175 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1176 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001177
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001178daemon
1179 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1180 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001181 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1182 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001183
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001184default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
1185 By default haproxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
1186 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1187 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1188 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1189 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1190 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1191 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1192 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1193 not start with a slash ('/'):
1194 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1195 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1196
1197 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1198 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1199 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1200 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1201 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1202 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1203 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1204 each of them.
1205
1206 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1207 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1208 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1209 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1210 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1211 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1212 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1213 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1214
1215 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1216 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
1217 different haproxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
1218 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1219 made easily relocatable.
1220
1221 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1222 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1223 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1224 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1225 consistent across all configuration files.
1226
1227 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1228 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1229 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1230 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1231 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1232 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1233 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1234 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1235
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001236deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1237 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001238 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001239
1240deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001241 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001242 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1243
1244deviceatlas-separator <char>
1245 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1246 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1247
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001248deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001249 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1250 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1251 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001252
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001253external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001254 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1255 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001256 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1257 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1258 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1259 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1260 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001261
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001262gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001263 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001264 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1265 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001266 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1267 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001268 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001269
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001270group <group name>
1271 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1272 See also "gid" and "user".
1273
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001274hard-stop-after <time>
1275 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1276
1277 Arguments :
1278 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1279 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1280 SIGUSR1 signal.
1281
1282 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1283 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1284 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1285
1286 Example:
1287 global
1288 hard-stop-after 30s
1289
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001290h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1291 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1292 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1293 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1294 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001295 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001296 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1297 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1298 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1299 specified in a proxy.
1300
1301 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1302 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1303 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1304 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1305 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1306 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1307 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1308
1309 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1310 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1311 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1312 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1313 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1314
1315 Example:
1316 global
1317 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1318
1319 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1320 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1321
1322h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1323 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1324 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1325 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1326 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1327 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1328 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1329 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1330 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1331
1332 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1333 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1334 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1335
1336 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1337 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1338
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001339insecure-fork-wanted
1340 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1341 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1342 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1343 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1344 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1345 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1346 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1347 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1348 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1349 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1350 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1351 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1352 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1353 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1354 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1355 disable it.
1356
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001357insecure-setuid-wanted
1358 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1359 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1360 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1361 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1362 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1363 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1364 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1365 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1366 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1367 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1368 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1369 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1370 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1371 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1372
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001373issuers-chain-path <dir>
1374 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1375 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1376 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1377 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1378 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1379 "issuers-chain-path".
1380 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1381 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1382 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1383 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1384 will share the chain in memory.
1385
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001386localpeer <name>
1387 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1388 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1389 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1390 the configuration parsing.
1391
1392 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1393 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1394
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001395log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001396 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001397 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001398 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001399 configured with "log global".
1400
1401 <address> can be one of:
1402
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001403 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001404 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1405 port).
1406
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001407 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1408 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1409 port).
1410
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001411 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001412 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1413 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001414 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001415
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001416 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1417 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1418 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1419 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1420 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1421 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1422 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1423 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1424 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1425 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1426 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1427 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1428 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1429 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001430 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1431 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001432
1433 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1434 "fd@2", see above.
1435
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001436 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1437 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1438 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1439 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1440 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001442 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1443 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001444
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001445 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1446 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1447 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1448 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1449 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1450 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1451 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1452 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1453 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1454 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001455 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1456 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001457
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001458 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1459 one of the following :
1460
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001461 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1462 field is stripped. This is the default.
1463 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1464 rfc3164.
1465
1466 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001467 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1468
1469 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1470 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1471
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001472 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1473 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1474 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1475 designed to be used with a local log server.
1476
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001477 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1478 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1479 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1480 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1481 logger consumes.
1482
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001483 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1484 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1485 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1486 used with a local log server.
1487
1488 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1489 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1490 designed to be used with a local log server.
1491
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001492 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1493 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1494 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1495 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1496
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001497 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1498 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1499 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1500 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1501 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1502
1503 <sample_size>
1504 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1505 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1506 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1507 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1508 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1509
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001510 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001511
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001512 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1513 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1514 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1515
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001516 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1517 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1518 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1519 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001520
1521 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001522 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1523 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1524 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1525 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1526 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1527 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001528
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001529 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001530
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001531log-send-hostname [<string>]
1532 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1533 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1534 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1535 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1536 the logs.
1537
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001538log-tag <string>
1539 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1540 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1541 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001542 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001543
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001544lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001545 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1546 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1547 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1548 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1549 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1550 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001551 used multiple times.
1552
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001553lua-load-per-thread <file>
1554 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1555 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1556 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1557 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1558 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1559 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1560 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1561 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1562 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1563 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1564 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1565 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1566 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1567 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1568 times.
1569
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001570lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1571 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1572 variable.
1573 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1574 to "path".
1575
1576 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1577 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1578 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1579 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1580 will be checked earlier.
1581
1582 As an example by specifying the following path:
1583
1584 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1585 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1586
1587 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1588 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1589 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1590 paths if that does not exist either.
1591
1592 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1593 documentation.
1594
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001595master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001596 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1597 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1598 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001599 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001600 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1601 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001602 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1603 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1604 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1605 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1606 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001607
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001608 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001609
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001610mworker-max-reloads <number>
1611 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001612 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001613 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1614 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1615 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1616
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001617nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001618 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1619 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1620 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001621 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1622 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001623 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1624 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1625 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001626
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001627nbthread <number>
1628 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001629 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1630 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1631 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1632 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1633 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001634 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1635 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1636 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1637 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1638 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1639 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1640 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001641
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001642numa-cpu-mapping
1643 By default, if running on Linux, haproxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
1644 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1645 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1646 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1647 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1648 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1649 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1650 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1651 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1652
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001653pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001654 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1655 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1656 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1657 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001658
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001659pp2-never-send-local
1660 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1661 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1662 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1663 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1664 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1665 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1666 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1667 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1668 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1669 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1670 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1671
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001672presetenv <name> <value>
1673 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1674 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1675 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1676 and "unsetenv".
1677
1678resetenv [<name> ...]
1679 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1680 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1681 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1682 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1683 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1684 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1685 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1686 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1687
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001688stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001689 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1690 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1691 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1692 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1693 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1694 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001695 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001696 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1697 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1698 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1699 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001700
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001701server-state-base <directory>
1702 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001703 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1704 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001705
1706server-state-file <file>
1707 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1708 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1709 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1710 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1711 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1712 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1713 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1714 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001715 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1716 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001717
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001718set-var <var-name> <expr>
1719 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1720 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1721 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1722 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1723 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1724 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1725 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1726 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1727 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1728
1729 Example:
1730 global
1731 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1732 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1733 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1734
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001735setenv <name> <value>
1736 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1737 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1738 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1739 and "unsetenv".
1740
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001741set-dumpable
1742 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001743 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1744 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1745 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1746 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1747 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1748 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1749 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1750 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1751 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1752 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1753 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1754 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1755 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1756 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1757 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1758 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1759 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001760
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001761ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1762 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1763 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001764 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001765 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001766 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1767 information and recommendations see e.g.
1768 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1769 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1770 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1771 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001772
1773ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1774 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1775 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1776 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1777 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1778 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001779 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1780 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1781 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001782 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001783
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001784ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1786 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1787 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1788 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1789 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1790
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001791ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1792 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1793 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1794 keyword to see available options.
1795
1796 Example:
1797 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001798 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001799
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001800ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1801 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1802 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001803 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001804 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001805 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1806 information and recommendations see e.g.
1807 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1808 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1809 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1810 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1811 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001812
1813ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1815 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1816 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1817 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1818 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001819 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1820 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1821 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1822 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001823
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001824ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1826 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1827 keyword to see available options.
1828
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001829ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1830 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1831 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1832 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001833 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001834 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001835 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1836 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1837 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1838 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001839 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1840 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1841 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1842
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001843ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1844 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1845 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001846 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001847 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001848 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1849
1850 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001851
1852 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1853 and won't try to remove them.
1854
1855 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1856
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001857ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001858 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001859 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1860 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001861
1862 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1863 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1864 optimize the startup time.
1865
1866 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1867 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1868 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1869
1870 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001871 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001872
1873 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001874 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1875
1876 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1877 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1878 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1879 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1880 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1881 bind configuration..
1882
1883 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1884 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1885 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1886 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1887 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1888 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1889 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1890 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1891
1892 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1893
1894 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1895 a cert bundle.
1896
1897 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1898 separately in several "crt".
1899
1900 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1901 since files are loading separately.
1902
1903 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1904 required to commit them.
1905
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001906 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001907 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001908
1909 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1910
1911 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1912
1913 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1914 not provided in the PEM file.
1915
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001916 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1917 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1918
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001919 The default behavior is "all".
1920
1921 Example:
1922 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1923 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1924 ssl-load-extra-files none
1925
1926 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1927
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001928ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1929 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1930 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1931 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1932
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001933ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001934 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001935 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1936 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1937 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1938 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1939 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1940 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001941 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001942
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001943stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1944 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1945 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1946 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001947 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001948 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001949
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001950 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1951 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1952 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001953
1954stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1955 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1956 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001957 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001958
1959stats maxconn <connections>
1960 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1961 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1962
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001963uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001964 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001965 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1966 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1967 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1968
1969ulimit-n <number>
1970 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1971 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1972 option.
1973
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001974unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1975 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1976
1977 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1978 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1979 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1980 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1981 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1982 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1983 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1984 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1985 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1986 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1987
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001988unsetenv [<name> ...]
1989 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1990 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1991 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1992 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1993 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1994 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1995 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1996
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001997user <user name>
1998 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1999 See also "uid" and "group".
2000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002001node <name>
2002 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2003
2004 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2005 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2006 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2007 traffic.
2008
2009description <text>
2010 Add a text that describes the instance.
2011
2012 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2013 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2014 "<" and ">" characters.
2015
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100201651degrees-data-file <file path>
2017 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002018 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002019
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002020 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002021 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2022
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000202351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002024 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2025 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2026 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2027
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002028 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002029 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2030
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200203151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002032 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2033 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2034
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002035 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
2036 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2037
203851degrees-cache-size <number>
2039 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2040 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2041 By default, this cache is disabled.
2042
2043 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002044 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2045
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002046wurfl-data-file <file path>
2047 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2048 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2049
2050 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2051 with USE_WURFL=1.
2052
2053wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2054 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2055 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2056 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2057
2058 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2059
2060 Valid WURFL properties are:
2061 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2062
2063 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2064 device.
2065
2066 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2067 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2068
2069 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2070 particular web request.
2071
2072 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2073 used Libwurfl API version.
2074
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002075 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2076 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2077
2078 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2079 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2080
2081 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2082
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002083 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2084 with USE_WURFL=1.
2085
2086wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2087 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2088 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2089
2090 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2091 with USE_WURFL=1.
2092
2093wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2094 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2095 thus before the chroot.
2096
2097 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2098 with USE_WURFL=1.
2099
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002100wurfl-cache-size <size>
2101 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2102 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002103 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002104 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002105
2106 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2107 with USE_WURFL=1.
2108
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002109strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002110 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
2111 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2112 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2113 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2114 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021163.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002117-----------------------
2118
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002119busy-polling
2120 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2121 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2122 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2123 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2124 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2125 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2126 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2127 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2128 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2129 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2130 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2131 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2132 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2133 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2134 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2135 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2136 "poll" pollers.
2137
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002138 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2139 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2140 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2141
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002142max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2143 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2144 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2145 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2146 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2147 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2148 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2149 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2150 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002152maxconn <number>
2153 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2154 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2155 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002156 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2157 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2158 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2159 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002160 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2161 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2162 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2163 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2164 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2165 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002166
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002167maxconnrate <number>
2168 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2169 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2170 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2171 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2172 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2173 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2174 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2175 fairness.
2176
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002177maxcomprate <number>
2178 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002179 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002180 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2181 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2182 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002183 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002184 default value.
2185
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002186maxcompcpuusage <number>
2187 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2188 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2189 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2190 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2191 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2192 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2193 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2194 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2195
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002196maxpipes <number>
2197 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2198 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2199 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2200 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2201 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2202 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2203
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002204maxsessrate <number>
2205 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2206 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2207 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2208 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2209 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2210 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2211 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2212 fairness.
2213
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002214maxsslconn <number>
2215 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2216 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2217 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2218 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2219 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2220 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2221 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002222 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2223 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2224 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2225 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2226 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2227 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2228 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002229
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002230maxsslrate <number>
2231 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2232 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2233 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2234 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2235 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2236 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2237 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2238 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2239 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2240 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2241
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002242maxzlibmem <number>
2243 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2244 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2245 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002246 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2247 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2248 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2249
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002250noepoll
2251 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2252 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002253 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002254
2255nokqueue
2256 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2257 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2258 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2259
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002260noevports
2261 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2262 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2263 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2264 also "nopoll".
2265
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002266nopoll
2267 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2268 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002269 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002270 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2271 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002272
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002273nosplice
2274 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002275 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002276 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002277 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002278 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2279 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2280 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2281 "option splice-response".
2282
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002283nogetaddrinfo
2284 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2285 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2286
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002287noreuseport
2288 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2289 command line argument "-dR".
2290
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002291profiling.memory { on | off }
2292 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2293 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2294 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2295 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2296 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2297 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2298 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2299 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2300 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2301
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002302profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2303 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2304 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2305 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2306 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002307 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002308 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2309 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2310 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2311 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2312
2313 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2314 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2315 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2316 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2317 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002318 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2319 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2320 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2321 CLI.
2322
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002323spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002324 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2325 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2326 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2327 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2328 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2329 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002330
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002331ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002332 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002333 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002334 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2335 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2336 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2337 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2338 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002339 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2340 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002341 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2342 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2343 openssl configuration file uses:
2344 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2345
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002346ssl-mode-async
2347 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002348 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002349 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2350 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2351 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002352 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002353 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002354
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002355tune.buffers.limit <number>
2356 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2357 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2358 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2359 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2360 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002361 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002362 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2363 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2364 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2365 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2366 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2367 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2368 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2369 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2370 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2371
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002372tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2373 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2374 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2375 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2376 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2377
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002378tune.bufsize <number>
2379 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2380 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2381 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2382 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2383 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2384 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2385 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002386 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2387 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2388 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002389 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002390 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2391 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2392 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002393
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002394tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2395 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002396
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002397tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2398 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2399 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2400 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2401 this value. The default value is 1.
2402
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002403tune.fail-alloc
2404 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2405 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2406 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2407 gracefully.
2408
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002409tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2410 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2411 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2412 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2413 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2414 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2415
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002416tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2417 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2418 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2419 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2420 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2421 change it.
2422
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002423tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2424 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002425 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2426 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002427 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2428 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2429 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2430 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2431 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2432
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002433tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2434 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2435 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2436 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2437 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2438 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2439 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2440 recommended not to change this value.
2441
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002442tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2443 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2444 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2445 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2446 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2447 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2448 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2449 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2450
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002451tune.http.cookielen <number>
2452 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2453 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2454 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2455 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2456 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2457 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2458 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2459 to change this value.
2460
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002461tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002462 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2463 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002464 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002465 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002466 configuration directives too.
2467 The default value is 1024.
2468
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002469tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2470 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2471 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2472 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2473 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2474 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2475 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002476 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2477 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2478 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002479
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002480tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2481 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2482 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2483 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2484 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2485 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2486 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002487 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2488 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2489 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2490 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2491 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002492
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002493tune.idletimer <timeout>
2494 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2495 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2496 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2497 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2498 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2499 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002500 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002501 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002502 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2503
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002504tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2505 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2506 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2507 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2508 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2509 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2510 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2511 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2512 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2513 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2514
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002515tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2516 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002517 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002518 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2519 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002520 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002521 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2522 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2523
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002524tune.lua.maxmem
2525 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2526 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2527 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2528 memory.
2529
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002530tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2531 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002532 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2533 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002534 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002535
2536tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2537 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2538 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2539 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2540 check servers.
2541
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002542tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2543 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2544 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2545 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002546 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002547
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002548tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002549 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2550 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002551 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2552 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2553 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2554 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2555 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2556 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2557 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2558 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2559 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002560
2561tune.maxpollevents <number>
2562 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2563 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2564 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2565 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2566 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2567
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002568tune.maxrewrite <number>
2569 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2570 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2571 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2572 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2573 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2574 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2575 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2576 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2577 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2578 bufsize.
2579
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002580tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2581 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2582 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2583 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2584 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2585 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2586 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2587 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2588 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2589 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002590 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2591 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002592 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2593 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2594 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2595 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2596 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2597 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2598 setting this parameter to 0.
2599
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002600tune.pipesize <number>
2601 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2602 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2603 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2604 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2605 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2606 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2607
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002608tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2609 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2610 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2611 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2612 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2613 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2614 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002615 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002616
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002617tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2618 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2619 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2620 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2621 default is 20.
2622
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002623tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2624tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2625 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2626 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2627 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002628 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002629 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002630 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2631 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2632
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002633tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002634 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002635 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2636 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2637 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2638 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2639
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002640tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002641 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002642 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2643 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2644 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2645 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2646 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2647 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2648 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002649
2650tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2651 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2652 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2653 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2654 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2655 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2656 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2657 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2658 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2659 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002660
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002661tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2662tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2663 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2664 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2665 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002666 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002667 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002668 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2669 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2670 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2671 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2672 notifying haproxy again.
2673
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002674tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002675 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002676 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2677 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2678 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2679 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2680 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2681 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2682 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2683 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2684 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2685 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2686 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002687
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002688tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002689 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002690 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2691 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2692 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2693 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2694 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2695
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002696tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2697 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2698 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2699 performances. This is disabled by default.
2700
2701 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2702 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2703
2704 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2705
2706 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2707
2708 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2709
2710 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2711 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2712 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2713
2714 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2715 converted.
2716
2717 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2718 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2719 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2720 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2721 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2722 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2723 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002724 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2725 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002726
2727 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2728
2729 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2730 only need this line:
2731
2732 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2733
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002734tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2735 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002736 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002737 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2738 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2739 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2740 being used for too long.
2741
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002742tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2743 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2744 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2745 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2746 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2747 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2748 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2749 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2750 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2751 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2752 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002753 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002754 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002755
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002756tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2757 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2758 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2759 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2760 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002761 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002762 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2763 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002764 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2765 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002766
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002767tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2768 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2769 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2770 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2771 1000 entries.
2772
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002773tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2774 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2775 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2776 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2777
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002778tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002779tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002780tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2781tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2782tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002783 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2784 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2785 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2786 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2787 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2788 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2789 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2790 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002791
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002792 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2793 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2794 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2795 all available space is consumed.
2796 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2797 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2798 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002799
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002800tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2801 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002802 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002803 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002804 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002805 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2806
2807tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2808 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2809 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002810 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2811 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028133.3. Debugging
2814--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002815
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002816quiet
2817 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2818 line argument "-q".
2819
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002820zero-warning
2821 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2822 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2823 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2824 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2825 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2826 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2827
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028293.4. Userlists
2830--------------
2831It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2832http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2833it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2834
2835userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002836 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002837 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2838
2839group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002840 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002841 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2842 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2843
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002844user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2845 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002846 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2847 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002848 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2849 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2850 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2851 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002852
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002853 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2854 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2855 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2856 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2857 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2858 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2859 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2860 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2861 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002862
2863 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002864 userlist L1
2865 group G1 users tiger,scott
2866 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002867
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002868 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2869 user scott insecure-password elgato
2870 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002871
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002872 userlist L2
2873 group G1
2874 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002875
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002876 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2877 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2878 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002879
2880 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002881
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002882
28833.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002884----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002885It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2886several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2887instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2888values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2889automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2890In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2891using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2892tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2893reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2894Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2895that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2896each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002897
2898peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002899 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002900 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2901
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002902bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2903 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2904 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2905
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002906disabled
2907 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2908 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2909 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2910
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002911default-bind [param*]
2912 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2913
2914default-server [param*]
2915 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2916
2917 Arguments:
2918 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2919 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2920 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2921 details.
2922
2923
2924 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2925
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002926enable
2927 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2928
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002929log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002930 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2931 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2932 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2933 more details.
2934
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002935peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002936 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2937 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002938 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2939 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2940 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2941 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2942 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002943
2944 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2945 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2946
2947 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002948 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2949 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2950 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002951
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002952 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2953 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002954
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002955 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2956 "server" keyword explanation below).
2957
2958server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002959 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002960 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2961 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2962 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2963 of this "peers" section).
2964 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2965
2966
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002967 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002968 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002969 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002970 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2971 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2972 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002973
2974 backend mybackend
2975 mode tcp
2976 balance roundrobin
2977 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2978 stick on src
2979
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002980 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2981 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002982
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002983 Example:
2984 peers mypeers
2985 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2986 default-server ssl verify none
2987 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2988 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002989
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002990
2991table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2992 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2993
2994 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2995 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002996 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002997 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2998 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2999 "stick-table" keyword).
3000
3001 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3002 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3003 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3004 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3005 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3006 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3007 of the stick-table name as follows:
3008
3009 peers mypeers
3010 peer A ...
3011 peer B ...
3012 table t1 ...
3013
3014 frontend fe1
3015 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3016
3017 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3018 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3019
3020 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3021 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3022 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3023 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3024 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3025 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3026 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3027
3028 peers mypeers
3029 peer A ...
3030 peer B ...
3031 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3032
3033 backend t1
3034 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3035
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003036 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003037 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3038 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3039
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030403.6. Mailers
3041------------
3042It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3043If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3044in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3045
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003046mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003047 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3048 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3049
3050mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3051 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3052
3053 Example:
3054 mailers mymailers
3055 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3056 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3057
3058 backend mybackend
3059 mode tcp
3060 balance roundrobin
3061
3062 email-alert mailers mymailers
3063 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3064 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3065
3066 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3067 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3068
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003069timeout mail <time>
3070 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3071 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3072 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3073 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3074
3075 Example:
3076 mailers mymailers
3077 timeout mail 20s
3078 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003079
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020030803.7. Programs
3081-------------
3082In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3083master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3084managed the same way as the workers.
3085
3086During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3087sequence as a worker:
3088
3089 - the master is re-executed
3090 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3091 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3092 instance of the program
3093
3094During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3095
3096program <name>
3097 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3098 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3099 the management guide).
3100
3101command <command> [arguments*]
3102 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3103 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3104 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3105 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3106
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003107user <user name>
3108 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3109 See also "group".
3110
3111group <group name>
3112 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3113 See also "user".
3114
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003115option start-on-reload
3116no option start-on-reload
3117 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3118 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3119 program section.
3120
3121
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031223.8. HTTP-errors
3123----------------
3124
3125It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3126imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3127several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3128
3129http-errors <name>
3130 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3131 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3132
3133errorfile <code> <file>
3134 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3135
3136 Arguments :
3137 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003138 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003139 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003140
3141 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3142 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3143 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3144 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3145 before any chroot is performed.
3146
3147 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3148
3149 Example:
3150 http-errors website-1
3151 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3152 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3153 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3154
3155 http-errors website-2
3156 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3157 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3158 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3159
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031603.9. Rings
3161----------
3162
3163It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3164servers or traces.
3165
3166ring <ringname>
3167 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3168
3169description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003170 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003171 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3172
3173format <format>
3174 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3175
3176 Arguments:
3177 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3178 one of the following :
3179
3180 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3181 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3182 designed to be used with a local log server.
3183
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003184 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3185 field is stripped. This is the default.
3186 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3187 rfc3164.
3188
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003189 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3190 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3191 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3192 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3193 is the default.
3194
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003195 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003196 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3197
3198 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3199 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3200
3201 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3202 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3203 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3204 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3205 logger consumes.
3206
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003207 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3208 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3209 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3210 with a local log server.
3211
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003212 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3213 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3214 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3215 used with a local log server.
3216
3217maxlen <length>
3218 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3219 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3220 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3221
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003222server <name> <address> [param*]
3223 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3224 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3225 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3226 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3227 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3228 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3229 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3230 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3231 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003232 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3233 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003234
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003235size <size>
3236 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3237 set to BUFSIZE.
3238
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003239timeout connect <timeout>
3240 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3241
3242 Arguments :
3243 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3244 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3245 as explained at the top of this document.
3246
3247timeout server <timeout>
3248 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3249
3250 Arguments :
3251 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3252 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3253 as explained at the top of this document.
3254
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003255 Example:
3256 global
3257 log ring@myring local7
3258
3259 ring myring
3260 description "My local buffer"
3261 format rfc3164
3262 maxlen 1200
3263 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003264 timeout connect 5s
3265 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003266 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003267
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020032683.10. Log forwarding
3269-------------------
3270
3271It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3272haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3273
3274log-forward <name>
3275 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3276
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003277backlog <conns>
3278 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3279 on connections accept.
3280
3281bind <addr> [param*]
3282 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003283 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3284 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3285 syslog protocol over TCP.
3286 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003287 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3288
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003289dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003290 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3291 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3292 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3293 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003294 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003295
3296log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003297log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003298 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3299 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3300 documentation.
3301 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3302 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3303 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3304 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3305 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3306
3307 Example:
3308 global
3309 log stderr format iso local7
3310
3311 ring myring
3312 description "My local buffer"
3313 format rfc5424
3314 maxlen 1200
3315 size 32764
3316 timeout connect 5s
3317 timeout server 10s
3318 # syslog tcp server
3319 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3320
3321 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003322 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3323 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003324 # all messages on stderr
3325 log global
3326 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3327 log ring@myring local0
3328 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3329 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3330 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3331 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3332 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003333
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003334maxconn <conns>
3335 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3336 10 is the default.
3337
3338timeout client <timeout>
3339 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033414. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003342----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003343
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003344Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003345 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3346 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3347 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3348 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003349
3350A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3351connections.
3352
3353A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3354to forward incoming connections.
3355
3356A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3357parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3358
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003359A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3360ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3361sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3362the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3363explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3364from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3365"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3366for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3367to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3368optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3369are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3370any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3371names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3372that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3373duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3374names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3375
3376Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3377settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3378of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3379profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3380timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3381
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003382All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3383'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3384case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3385
3386Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3387logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3388proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3389However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3390name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3391
3392Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3393and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003394bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003395protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3396modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3397arbitrary criteria.
3398
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003399In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3400a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003401the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003402
3403 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3404 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3405 between responses and new requests.
3406
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003407 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3408 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3409 client-facing connection remains open.
3410
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003411 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3412 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003413
3414The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3415frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3416following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003417weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003418
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003419 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003420
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003421 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3422 ----+-----+-----+----
3423 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3424 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003425 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3426 ----+-----+-----+----
3427 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003428
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003429It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3430only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3431into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3432as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3433content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3434and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3435possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003436
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003437There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3438first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3439processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3440second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3441protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3442is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3443new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3444to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3445process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3446already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3447HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3448evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3449one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3450
3451There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3452performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3453tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3454preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3455analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3456HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3457header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3458mitigate this drawback.
3459
3460It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3461method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3462set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3463in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3464is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3465to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3466above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3467to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3468"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3469frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3470frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3471as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3472upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3473on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3474the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3475upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3476frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3477remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034794.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3480--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003482The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3483limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3484they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3485limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003486marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003487option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003488and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3489with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3490specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003491
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003492
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003493 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3494------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3495acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003496backlog X X X -
3497balance X - X X
3498bind - X X -
3499bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003500capture cookie - X X -
3501capture request header - X X -
3502capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003503clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3504clitcpka-idle X X X -
3505clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003506compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003507cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003508declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003509default-server X - X X
3510default_backend X X X -
3511description - X X X
3512disabled X X X X
3513dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003514email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003515email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003516email-alert mailers X X X X
3517email-alert myhostname X X X X
3518email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003519enabled X X X X
3520errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003521errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003522errorloc X X X X
3523errorloc302 X X X X
3524-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3525errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003526force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003527filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003528fullconn X - X X
3529grace X X X X
3530hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003531http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003532http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003533http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003534http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003535http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003536http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003537http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003538http-check set-var X - X X
3539http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003540http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003541http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003542http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003543http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003544http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003545id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003546ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003547load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003548log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003549log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003550log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003551log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003552max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003553maxconn X X X -
3554mode X X X X
3555monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003556monitor-uri X X X -
3557option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3558option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3559option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3560option allbackups (*) X - X X
3561option checkcache (*) X - X X
3562option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3563option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003564option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003565option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3566option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003567-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3568option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003569option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3570option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003571option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003572option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003573option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003574option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003575option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003576option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3577option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3578option httpchk X - X X
3579option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003580option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003581option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003582option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003583option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003584option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003585option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3586option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3587option logasap (*) X X X -
3588option mysql-check X - X X
3589option nolinger (*) X X X X
3590option originalto X X X X
3591option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003592option pgsql-check X - X X
3593option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003594option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003595option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003596option smtpchk X - X X
3597option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3598option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3599option splice-request (*) X X X X
3600option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003601option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003602option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3603option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3604-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003605option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003606option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3607option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3608option tcpka X X X X
3609option tcplog X X X X
3610option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003611external-check command X - X X
3612external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003613persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3614rate-limit sessions X X X -
3615redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003616-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003617retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003618retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003619server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003620server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003621server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003622source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003623srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3624srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3625srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003626stats admin - X X X
3627stats auth X X X X
3628stats enable X X X X
3629stats hide-version X X X X
3630stats http-request - X X X
3631stats realm X X X X
3632stats refresh X X X X
3633stats scope X X X X
3634stats show-desc X X X X
3635stats show-legends X X X X
3636stats show-node X X X X
3637stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003638-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3639stick match - - X X
3640stick on - - X X
3641stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003642stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003643stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003644tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003645tcp-check connect X - X X
3646tcp-check expect X - X X
3647tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003648tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003649tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003650tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003651tcp-check set-var X - X X
3652tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003653tcp-request connection - X X -
3654tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003655tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003656tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003657tcp-response content - - X X
3658tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003659timeout check X - X X
3660timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003661timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003662timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003663timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3664timeout http-request X X X X
3665timeout queue X - X X
3666timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003667timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003668timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003669timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003670transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003671unique-id-format X X X -
3672unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003673use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003674use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003675use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003676------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3677 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003678
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036804.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3681---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003682
3683This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3684
3685
3686acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3687 Declare or complete an access list.
3688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3689 no | yes | yes | yes
3690 Example:
3691 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3692 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3693 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003695 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003696
3697
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003698backlog <conns>
3699 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3701 yes | yes | yes | no
3702 Arguments :
3703 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3704 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003705 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003706
3707 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3708 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3709 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3710 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3711 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3712 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3713 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3714 backlog parameter.
3715
3716 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3717 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3718 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3719
3720 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3721
3722
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003723balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003724balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003725 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3727 yes | no | yes | yes
3728 Arguments :
3729 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3730 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3731 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3732 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3733
3734 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3735 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3736 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3737 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003738 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003739 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003740 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3741 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3742 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3743 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3744 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3745 it, so that you don't worry.
3746
3747 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3748 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3749 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3750 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3751 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3752 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3753 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3754 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003755
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003756 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3757 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3758 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3759 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3760 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3761 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3762 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003763 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3764 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3765 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003766
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003767 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003768 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003769 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3770 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003771 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003772 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3773 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3774 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3775 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3776 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003777 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3778 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3779 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3780 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3781 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3782 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003783
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003784 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3785 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3786 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3787 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3788 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3789 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3790 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3791 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003792 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003793 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003794 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3795 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3796 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003797
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003798 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3799 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3800 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3801 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3802 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3803 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3804 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3805 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3806 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3807 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3808 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3809 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003810
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003811 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003812 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3813 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3814 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3815 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3816 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3817 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3818 URIs start with a leading "/".
3819
3820 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3821 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3822 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3823 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3824
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003825 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3826 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3827 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3828 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3829
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003830 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003831 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3832
3833 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003834 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3835 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003836 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3837 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3838 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3839 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003840 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003841 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3842 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003843
3844 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3845 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3846 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3847 server will receive the request.
3848
3849 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3850 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3851 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3852 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3853 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003854 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3855 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3856 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003857
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003858 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3859 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3860 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3861 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3862 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003863
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003864 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003865 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3866 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3867 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3868
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003869 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3870 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3871 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3872
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003873 random
3874 random(<draws>)
3875 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003876 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3877 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3878 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3879 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003880 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3881 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3882 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3883 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3884 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3885 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3886 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3887 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3888 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3889 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3890 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3891 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3892 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3893 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3894 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3895 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3896 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3897 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3898 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3899 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003900
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003901 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003902 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003903 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3904 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3905 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3906 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3907 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3908 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003909 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003910 used instead.
3911
3912 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3913 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3914 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3915 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3916
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003917 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3918 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3919 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3920
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003921 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003922
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003923 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003924 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3925 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003926
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003927 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3928 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3929 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003930
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003931 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003932 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003933 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3934 NTLM relies on.
3935
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003936 Examples :
3937 balance roundrobin
3938 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003939 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003940 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3941 balance hdr(host)
3942 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003943
3944 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3945 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003947 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003948 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3949 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3950 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003951 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003952
3953 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3954 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3955 defaults to 16 kB.
3956
3957 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3958 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3959
3960 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3961 Round Robin.
3962
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003963 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003964 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3965 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3966 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3967
3968 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3969
3970 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003971 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003972 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3973 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3974 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003975
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003976 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003977
3978
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003979bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3980bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003981 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3983 no | yes | yes | no
3984 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003985 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3986 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3987 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3988 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003989 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003990 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3991 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3992 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3993 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3994 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3995 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003996 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003997 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3998 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003999 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004000 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4001 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004002 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004003 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4004 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004005 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004006 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4007 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4008 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4009 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4010 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4011 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4012 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004013 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4014 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4015 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004016 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4017 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4018 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4019 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004020 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4021 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4022 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004023
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004024 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4025 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004026 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4027 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4028 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004029 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4030 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4031 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4032 the range.
4033
4034 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4035 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4036 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4037 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4038 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4039 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4040 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004041 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004042 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004043
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004044 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004045 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004046 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4047 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4048 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4049 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4050 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4051 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4052
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004053 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4054 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4055 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4056 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004057
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004058 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4059 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4060 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4061 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4062 in a frontend.
4063
4064 Example :
4065 listen http_proxy
4066 bind :80,:443
4067 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004068 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004069
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004070 listen http_https_proxy
4071 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004072 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004073
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004074 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4075 bind ipv6@:80
4076 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4077 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4078
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004079 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004080 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004081
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004082 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4083 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4084 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4085 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4086 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4087
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004088 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004089 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090
4091
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004092bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004093 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4095 yes | yes | yes | yes
4096 Arguments :
4097 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4098 may be used to override a default value.
4099
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004100 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004101 option may be combined with other numbers.
4102
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004103 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004104 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4105 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4106 missing from all processes.
4107
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004108 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004109 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004110 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4111 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4112 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4113 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4114 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004115 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004116
4117 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4118 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4119 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4120 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4121 and 'even' instances.
4122
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004123 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4124 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4125 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4126 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004127
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004128 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4129 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4130
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004131 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4132 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4133 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4134
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004135 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4136 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4137
4138 Example :
4139 listen app_ip1
4140 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004141 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004142
4143 listen app_ip2
4144 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004145 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004146
4147 listen management
4148 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004149 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004150
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004151 listen management
4152 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4153 bind-process 1-4
4154
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004155 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004156
4157
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004158capture cookie <name> len <length>
4159 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4161 no | yes | yes | no
4162 Arguments :
4163 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4164 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4165 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4166 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004167 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004168
4169 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4170 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4171 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4172 right if it exceeds <length>.
4173
4174 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4175 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4176 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4177 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4178
4179 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4180 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4181 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4182
4183 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4184 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4185 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004186 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4187 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4188 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004189
4190 Example:
4191 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4192
4193 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004194 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004195
4196
4197capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004198 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4200 no | yes | yes | no
4201 Arguments :
4202 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004203 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004204 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4205 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4206 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4207
4208 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4209 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4210 it exceeds <length>.
4211
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004212 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004213 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4214 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004215 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4216 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4217 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4218 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004219 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004220 environments to find where the request came from.
4221
4222 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4223 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4224 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4225 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004226
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004227 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4228 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4229 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4230 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4231 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004232
4233 Example:
4234 capture request header Host len 15
4235 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004236 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004238 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004239 about logging.
4240
4241
4242capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004243 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4245 no | yes | yes | no
4246 Arguments :
4247 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004248 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004249 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4250 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4251 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4252
4253 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4254 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4255 it exceeds <length>.
4256
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004257 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004258 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4259 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4260 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004261 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4262 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4263 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4264 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004265
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004266 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4267 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4268 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4269 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4270 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004271
4272 Example:
4273 capture response header Content-length len 9
4274 capture response header Location len 15
4275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004276 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004277 about logging.
4278
4279
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004280clitcpka-cnt <count>
4281 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4282 the connection on the client side.
4283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4284 yes | yes | yes | no
4285 Arguments :
4286 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4287
4288 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4289 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004290 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4291 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004292
4293 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4294
4295
4296clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4297 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4298 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4299 client side.
4300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4301 yes | yes | yes | no
4302 Arguments :
4303 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4304 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4305 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4306 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4307
4308 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4309 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004310 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4311 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004312
4313 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4314
4315
4316clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4317 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4319 yes | yes | yes | no
4320 Arguments :
4321 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4322 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4323 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4324 document.
4325
4326 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4327 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004328 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4329 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004330
4331 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4332
4333
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004334compression algo <algorithm> ...
4335compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004336compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004337 Enable HTTP compression.
4338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4339 yes | yes | yes | yes
4340 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004341 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4342 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4343 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4344
4345 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004346 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4347 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4348 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004349
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004350 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004351 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004352
4353 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4354 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4355 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4356 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4357 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004358 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004359
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004360 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4361 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4362 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4363 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4364 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4365 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4366 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004367 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004368
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004369 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004370 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004371 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4372 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4373 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4374 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4375 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004376
4377 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4378 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4379 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4380 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4381 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004382 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4383 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4384 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4385 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4386 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004387 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4388 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004389
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004390 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004391 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4392 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004393 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004394 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004395 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4396 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4397 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4398 "multipart"
4399 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4400 header
4401 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4402 and later
4403 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4404 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004405 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004406
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004407 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004408
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004409 Examples :
4410 compression algo gzip
4411 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004412
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004413
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004414cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004415 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4416 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004417 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004418 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4420 yes | no | yes | yes
4421 Arguments :
4422 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4423 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4424 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4425 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4426 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4427 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004428 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004429 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4430 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4431
4432 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4433 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4434 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4435 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4436 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4437 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004438 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4439 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004440 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004441 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4442 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004443
4444 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004445 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004446
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004447 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004448 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004449 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004450 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004451 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4452 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4453 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4454 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4455 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4456 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4457 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004458
4459 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4460 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4461 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4462 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4463 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4464 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4465 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4466 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4467 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004468 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004469 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4470 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4471 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004472
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004473 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4474 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4475 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004476 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4477 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4478 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4479 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004480 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4481 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4482 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004483
4484 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4485 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4486 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4487 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4488 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4489 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4490 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4491 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4492 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4493
4494 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4495 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4496 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4497 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4498 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4499 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4500 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4501 persistence cookie in the cache.
4502 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4503
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004504 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4505 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4506 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4507 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4508 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004509 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004510 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4511 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4512 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4513 they logout.
4514
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004515 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4516 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4517 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4518 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4519
4520 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4521 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4522 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4523 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4524 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4525 this attribute.
4526
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004527 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004528 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004529 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4530 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4531 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4532 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4533 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4534 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004535
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004536 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4537 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4538 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4539 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4540 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4541 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4542 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4543 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004544 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004545 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4546 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4547 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4548 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4549 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4550 the site.
4551
4552 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4553 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4554 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4555 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4556 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4557 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4558 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4559 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4560 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4561 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4562 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4563 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4564 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004565 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004566 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4567 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4568
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004569 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4570 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4571 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4572 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4573 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4574 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4575
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004576 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4577 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4578 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4579 repeated.
4580
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004581 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4582 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4583 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4584 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004586 Examples :
4587 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4588 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4589 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004590 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004591
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004592 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004593
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004594
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004595declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4596 Declares a capture slot.
4597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4598 no | yes | yes | no
4599 Arguments:
4600 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4601
4602 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4603 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4604 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4605 for use in the response.
4606
4607 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004608 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004609 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4610
4611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004612default-server [param*]
4613 Change default options for a server in a backend
4614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4615 yes | no | yes | yes
4616 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004617 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4618 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4619 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4620 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004621
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004622 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004623 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4624
4625 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004626
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004628default_backend <backend>
4629 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4631 yes | yes | yes | no
4632 Arguments :
4633 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4634
4635 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4636 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4637 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4638 will catch all undetermined requests.
4639
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004640 Example :
4641
4642 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4643 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4644 default_backend dynamic
4645
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004646 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004647
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004648
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004649description <string>
4650 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4652 no | yes | yes | yes
4653 Arguments : string
4654
4655 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4656 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4657 it describes.
4658 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4659
4660
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004661disabled
4662 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4664 yes | yes | yes | yes
4665 Arguments : none
4666
4667 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4668 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4669 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4670 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4671 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4672 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4673 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4674
4675 See also : "enabled"
4676
4677
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004678dispatch <address>:<port>
4679 Set a default server address
4680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004682 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004683
4684 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4685 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4686 during start-up.
4687
4688 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4689 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4690 possible with normal servers.
4691
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004692 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004693 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4694 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4695 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4696 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4697
4698 See also : "server"
4699
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004700
4701dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4702 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4704 yes | no | yes | yes
4705 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4706
4707 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004708 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004709 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4710 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004711 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004712 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004713
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004714enabled
4715 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4717 yes | yes | yes | yes
4718 Arguments : none
4719
4720 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4721 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4722
4723 See also : "disabled"
4724
4725
4726errorfile <code> <file>
4727 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4729 yes | yes | yes | yes
4730 Arguments :
4731 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004732 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004733 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004734
4735 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004736 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004737 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004738 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4739 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004740
4741 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4742 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4743 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4744
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004745 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4746
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004747 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4748 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4749 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4750 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4751 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4752 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4753 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4754 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4755 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004756
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004757 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4758 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4759 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004760 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004761 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4762
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004763 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004764
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004765 Example :
4766 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004767 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004768 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4769 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4770
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004771
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004772errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4773 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4774 section.
4775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4776 yes | yes | yes | yes
4777 Arguments :
4778 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4779
4780 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004781 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004782 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4783 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004784
4785 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4786 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4787 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4788 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4789 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004790 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004791 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4792
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004793 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4794 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004795
4796 Example :
4797 errorfiles generic
4798 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4799
4800
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004801errorloc <code> <url>
4802errorloc302 <code> <url>
4803 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4805 yes | yes | yes | yes
4806 Arguments :
4807 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004808 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004809 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004810
4811 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4812 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4813 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4814 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004815 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004816
4817 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4818 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4819 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4820
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004821 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4822
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004823 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4824 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4825 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4826 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004827 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004828 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4829 request.
4830
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004831 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004832
4833
4834errorloc303 <code> <url>
4835 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4837 yes | yes | yes | yes
4838 Arguments :
4839 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004840 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004841 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004842
4843 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4844 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4845 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4846 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004847 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004848
4849 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4850 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4851 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4852
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004853 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4854
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004855 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4856 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4857 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4858 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004859 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004860
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004861 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004862
4863
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004864email-alert from <emailaddr>
4865 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004866 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004867 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4868 yes | yes | yes | yes
4869
4870 Arguments :
4871
4872 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4873
4874 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4875 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4876
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004877 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004878 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4879 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004880
4881
4882email-alert level <level>
4883 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4884 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4885 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4886 yes | yes | yes | yes
4887
4888 Arguments :
4889
4890 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4891 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4892 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4893
4894 By default level is alert
4895
4896 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4897 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4898 for the proxy.
4899
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004900 Alerts are sent when :
4901
4902 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4903 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4904 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4905 is notice or lower
4906 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4907 and a health check status update occurs
4908
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004909 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4910 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004911 section 3.6 about mailers.
4912
4913
4914email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4915 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4916 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4917 yes | yes | yes | yes
4918
4919 Arguments :
4920
4921 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4922
4923 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4924 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4925
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004926 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4927 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004928
4929
4930email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4931 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4932 mailers.
4933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | yes | yes | yes
4935
4936 Arguments :
4937
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004938 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004939
4940 By default the systems hostname is used.
4941
4942 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4943 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4944 for the proxy.
4945
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004946 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4947 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004948
4949
4950email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004951 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004952 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4953 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4954 yes | yes | yes | yes
4955
4956 Arguments :
4957
4958 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4959
4960 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4961 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4962
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004963 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004964 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4965
4966
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004967force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4968 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4969 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004970 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004971
4972 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4973 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4974 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4975 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4976 marked down for maintenance operations.
4977
4978 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4979 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4980 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4981 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4982 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4983 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4984 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4985 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4986 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4987
4988 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4989 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4990 is used.
4991
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004992 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004993 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004994
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004995
4996filter <name> [param*]
4997 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4999 no | yes | yes | yes
5000 Arguments :
5001 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5002 referenced in section 9.
5003
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005004 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005005 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005006 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5007 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005008
5009 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5010 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5011
5012 Example:
5013 listen
5014 bind *:80
5015
5016 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5017 filter compression
5018 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5019
5020 compression algo gzip
5021 compression offload
5022
5023 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5024
5025 See also : section 9.
5026
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005027
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005028fullconn <conns>
5029 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5031 yes | no | yes | yes
5032 Arguments :
5033 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5034 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5035
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005036 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005037 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005038 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005039 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5040 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5041 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5042 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5043 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005044 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005045
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005046 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
5047 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005048 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5049 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5050 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005051
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005052 Example :
5053 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5054 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5055 # connections.
5056 backend dynamic
5057 fullconn 10000
5058 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5059 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5060
5061 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5062
5063
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005064grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005065 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005067 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005068 Arguments :
5069 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5070 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5071 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5072
5073 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5074 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005075 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005076 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5077
5078 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5079 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5080 simplify it.
5081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005082
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005083hash-balance-factor <factor>
5084 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5086 yes | no | no | yes
5087 Arguments :
5088 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5089 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005090 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005091
5092 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5093 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5094 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5095 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5096 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5097 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5098 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5099
5100 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5101 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5102 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5103 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5104 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5105
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005106 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5107 consistent hashing mechanism.
5108
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005109 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5110
5111
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005112hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005113 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5115 yes | no | yes | yes
5116 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005117 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5118 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005119
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005120 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5121 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5122 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5123 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5124 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5125 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5126 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5127 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5128 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5129 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005130
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005131 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5132 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5133 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5134 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5135 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5136 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5137 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5138 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5139 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5140 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5141 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5142 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5143 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005144 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5145 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005146
5147 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5148
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005149 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005150 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5151 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5152 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005153 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5154 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5155 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005156
5157 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5158 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005159 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5160 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5161 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5162 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5163
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005164 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5165 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5166 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5167 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5168 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5169 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5170 parameter.
5171
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005172 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5173 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5174 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5175 used on strings.
5176
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005177 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5178
5179 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5180 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5181 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5182 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5183 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5184 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5185 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5186 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5187 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5188 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5189 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5190 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005191
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005192 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5193 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5194 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005195
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005196 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005197
5198
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005199http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5200 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5201 ones).
5202
5203 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5204 no | yes | yes | yes
5205
5206 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5207 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5208 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5209 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5210 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5211 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5212
5213 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5214 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5215 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5216
5217 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5218 below.
5219
5220 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5221 instance.
5222
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005223 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5224 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5225 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5226
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005227 Example:
5228 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5229 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5230 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5231
5232http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5233
5234 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5235 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5236 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5237 example, or to pass some internal information.
5238 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5239 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5240 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5241
5242http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5243
5244 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5245 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5246
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005247http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005248
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005249 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5250 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5251 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5252 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5253 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005254
5255http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5256 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5257
5258 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5259
5260 Example:
5261 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5262
5263 # applied to:
5264 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5265
5266 # outputs:
5267 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5268
5269 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5270
5271http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5272 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5273
5274 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5275
5276 Example:
5277 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5278
5279 # applied to:
5280 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5281
5282 # outputs:
5283 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5284
5285http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5286
5287 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5288 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5289 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5290
5291http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5292 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5293
5294 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5295 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5296 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5297 fallback.
5298
5299 Example:
5300 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5301 http-response set-status 431
5302 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5303 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5304
5305http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5306
5307 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5308 inline.
5309
5310 Arguments:
5311 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5312 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5313 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5314 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5315 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5316 (request and response)
5317 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5318 processing
5319 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5320 processing
5321 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5322 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5323 and '_'.
5324
5325 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5326 followed by some converters.
5327
5328 Example:
5329 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5330
5331http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5332
5333 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5334 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5335 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5336 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5337 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005338 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005339 processing.
5340
5341 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5342 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005343 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005344 rules evaluation.
5345
5346http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5347
5348 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5349 details about <var-name>.
5350
5351 Example:
5352 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5353
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005354
5355http-check comment <string>
5356 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5357 it fails.
5358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5359 yes | no | yes | yes
5360
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005361 Arguments :
5362 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5363 rule fails.
5364
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005365 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5366 user-friendly error reporting.
5367
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005368 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005369 "http-check expect".
5370
5371
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005372http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5373 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005374 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005375 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5377 yes | no | yes | yes
5378
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005379 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005380 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5381
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005382 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005383 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005384
5385 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5386 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5387 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5388 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5389
5390 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5391
5392 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5393
5394 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5395
5396 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5397
5398 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5399
5400 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5401 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5402 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5403 is used.
5404
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005405 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5406 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5407 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5408 haproxy -vv.
5409
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005410 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5411
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005412 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5413 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5414 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5415 different ports or with different servers.
5416
5417 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5418 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5419 the port with a "http-check connect".
5420
5421 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5422 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5423 do.
5424
5425 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5426 unset-var or comment rules.
5427
5428 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005429 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5430 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5431 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5432 option httpchk
5433
5434 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005435 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005436 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005437 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005438 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005439 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005440
5441 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5442
5443 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005444
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005445
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005446http-check disable-on-404
5447 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005449 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005450 Arguments : none
5451
5452 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5453 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5454 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5455 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5456 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5457 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5458 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5459 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005460 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5461 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005462 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5463 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5464 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005465
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005466 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005467
5468
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005469http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005470 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5471 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5472 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005473 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005475 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005476
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005477 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005478 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5479
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005480 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5481 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5482 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5483 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5484 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5485 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5486 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5487 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5488 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5489 result is always conclusive.
5490
5491 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5492 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5493 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005494 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5495 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005496 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5497 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005498 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5499 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5500 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005501
5502 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5503 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005504 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5505 supported :
5506 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5507 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005508 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5509 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5510 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5511 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5512 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005513
5514 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5515 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005516 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5517 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5518 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5519 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005520 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5521
5522 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5523 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5524 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5525 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5526
5527 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5528 informational message reported in logs if an error
5529 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5530 log-format string.
5531
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005532 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005533 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5534 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005535 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5536 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5537 details on the supported keywords.
5538
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005539 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5540 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5541 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5542 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005543
5544 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5545 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5546 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5547 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5548 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5549
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005550 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5551 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5552 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5553 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5554 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5555 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5556 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005557
5558 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005559 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005560 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5561 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5562 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5563 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5564
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005565 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5566 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005567 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5568 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5569 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5570 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5571 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5572 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5573 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5574 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005575 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5576 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5577 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5578 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5579 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5580 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5581 insensitive on the header names.
5582
5583 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5584 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5585 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5586 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5587 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5588 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005589
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005590 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005591 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005592 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5593 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5594 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5595 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5596 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005597 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005598 trace).
5599
5600 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005601 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005602 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5603 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5604 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5605 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5606 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005607 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005608
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005609 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5610 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5611 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5612 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5613 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5614 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5615
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005616 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005617 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005618 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5619 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5620 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5621 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5622 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5623 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5624
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005625 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5626 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5627 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5628 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5629 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005630
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005631 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5632 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5633
5634 Examples :
5635 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005636 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005637
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005638 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5639 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5640
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005641 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005642 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005643
5644 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005645 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005646
5647 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005648 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005649
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005650 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005651 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005652
5653
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005654http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005655 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5656 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005657 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5658 health checks.
5659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5660 yes | no | yes | yes
5661 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005662 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5663
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005664 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5665 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5666 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5667 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5668 to invent non-standard ones.
5669
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005670 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5671 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5672 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5673 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5674
5675 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5676 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5677 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5678 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005679
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005680 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005681 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005682 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005683 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5684 to add it.
5685
5686 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5687 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5688 to the log-format rules.
5689
5690 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5691 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5692 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005693
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005694 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5695 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5696 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5697 request.
5698
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005699 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5700 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5701 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005702 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5703 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5704 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5705 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005706 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005707
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005708 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005709 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5710 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005711
5712 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5713 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5714 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5715 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5716 configured request authority.
5717
5718 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5719 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005720
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005721 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005722
5723
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005724http-check send-state
5725 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5727 yes | no | yes | yes
5728 Arguments : none
5729
5730 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5731 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5732 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5733 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5734 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5735
5736 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5737 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5738 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5739 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5740 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005741 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5742 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5743 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5744
5745 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5746 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5747 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5748
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005749 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5750 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5751 checked in multiple backends.
5752
5753 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5754 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5755
5756 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5757 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5758 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5759 one fails.
5760
5761 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5762 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5763 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5764
5765 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5766 server's queue.
5767
5768 Example of a header received by the application server :
5769 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5770 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5771
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005772 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5773 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005774
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005775
5776http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005777 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5779 yes | no | yes | yes
5780
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005781 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005782 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5783 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5784 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5785 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5786 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5787 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5788 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5789 and '-'.
5790
5791 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5792
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005793 Examples :
5794 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005795
5796
5797http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005798 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005799 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5800 yes | no | yes | yes
5801
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005802 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005803 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5804 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5805 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5806 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5807 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5808 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5809 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5810 and '-'.
5811
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005812 Examples :
5813 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005814
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005815
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005816http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5817 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5818 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5819 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5820 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5822 yes | yes | yes | yes
5823 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005824 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005825 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005826 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005827 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005828
5829 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5830 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5831 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5832 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5833
5834 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5835 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5836 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5837 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5838
5839 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5840 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5841 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5842 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5843 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5844 chroot is performed.
5845
5846 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5847 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5848 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5849 considered.
5850
5851 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5852 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5853 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5854 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5855 considered as a raw string.
5856
5857 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5858 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5859 "content-type".
5860
5861 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5862 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5863 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5864 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5865 evaluated as a log-format string.
5866
5867 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5868 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5869 argument to "content-type".
5870
5871 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5872 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5873 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5874 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5875
5876 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5877 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5878 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5879 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5880 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5881 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5882 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5883 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5884
5885 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5886 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5887 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5888
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005889 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5890 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5891 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5892 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5893 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5894
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005895 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5896 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5897
5898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005899http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005900 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5901
5902 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5903 no | yes | yes | yes
5904
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005905 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5906 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5907 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5908 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5909 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005910
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005911 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5912 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005914 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005915
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005916 Example:
5917 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5918 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5919 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005921 http-request allow if nagios
5922 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5923 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5924 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005925
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005926 Example:
5927 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5928 acl add path /addacl
5929 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005930
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005931 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005932
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005933 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5934 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005935
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005936 Example:
5937 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5938 acl setmap path /setmap
5939 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005940
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005941 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005943 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5944 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005945
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005946 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5947 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005948
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005949http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005950
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005951 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5952 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5953 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5954 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5955 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5956 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5957 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5958 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005959
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005960http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005962 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5963 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5964 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5965 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5966 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5967 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5968 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5969 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005970
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005971http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005972
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005973 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5974 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005975
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005976
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005977http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005978
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005979 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5980 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5981 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5982 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5983 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005984
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005985 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5986 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5987 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5988 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5989 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5990 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5991 instead.
5992
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005993 Example:
5994 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5995 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005996
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005997http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005998
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005999 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006000
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006001http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6002 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006004 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6005 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6006 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6007 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6008 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6009 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6010 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6011 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6012 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6015 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6016 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006017 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6018
6019 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6020 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6021 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6022 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006026 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6027 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6028 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6029 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6030 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6031 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006032
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006033http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006034
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006035 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6036 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6037 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6038 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6039 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006041http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6044 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6045 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6046 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6047 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6048 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006049
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006050http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6051http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6052 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6053 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6054 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6055 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006056
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006057 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6058 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6059 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006060 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006061 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6062 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6063 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006064 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006065 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006066
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006067http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6068 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6069 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6070 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6071
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006072http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6073
6074 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6075 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6076 pointed by <resolvers>.
6077 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6078 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6079 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6080 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6081 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6082 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6083 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6084 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6085 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6086 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6087 to 0.0.0.0.
6088
6089 Example:
6090 resolvers mydns
6091 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6092 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6093 timeout retry 1s
6094 hold valid 10s
6095 hold nx 3s
6096 hold other 3s
6097 hold obsolete 0s
6098 accepted_payload_size 8192
6099
6100 frontend fe
6101 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6102 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6103 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6104
6105 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6106 # which mean DNS resolution error
6107 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6108
6109 default_backend be
6110
6111 backend b_503
6112 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6113 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6114 # 503 error page to end users
6115
6116 backend be
6117 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6118 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6119 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6120 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6121 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6122
6123 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6124 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6125
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006126http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6127
6128 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6129 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6130 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6131 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006132 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6133 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006134
6135 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6136
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006137http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006138http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006139http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006140http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006141http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006142http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6143http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006144
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006145 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6146
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006147 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
6148 technical preview. You should be prepared that the behavior of normalizers
6149 might change to fix possible issues, possibly breaking proper request
6150 processing in your infrastructure.
6151
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006152 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6153 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6154 the supported backend.
6155
6156 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6157 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6158 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6159 number of segments in the path.
6160
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006161 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6162 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6163 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6164 when improperly combined.
6165
6166 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6167 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6168 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6169 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6170 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6171
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006172 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006173
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006174 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6175 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006176
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006177 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6178 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6179
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006180 Example:
6181 - /. -> /
6182 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6183 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6184 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006185
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006186 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6187 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6188
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006189 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006190 their preceding segment.
6191
6192 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6193 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6194
6195 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6196 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006197
6198 Example:
6199 - /foo/../ -> /
6200 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6201 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6202 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006203 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006204 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006205 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006206
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006207 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6208 removed as well:
6209
6210 Example:
6211 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6212 - /bar/../../ -> /
6213
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006214 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6215 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006216
6217 Example:
6218 - // -> /
6219 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6220
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006221 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6222 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6223
6224 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6225 ".", "_", and "~".
6226
6227 Example:
6228 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6229 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6230 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6231 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6232
6233 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6234 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6235
6236 Example:
6237 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6238 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6239
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006240 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006241 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006242
6243 Example:
6244 - /%6f -> /%6F
6245 - /%zz -> /%zz
6246
6247 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6248 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6249
6250 Example:
6251 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6252
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006253 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006254 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6255 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6256
6257 Example:
6258 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6259 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6260 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006262http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006264 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6265 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6266 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6267 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6268 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006270http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006272 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6273 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6274 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6275 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006277http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6278 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006279
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006280 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006281 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6282 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6283 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6284 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6285 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006286
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006287 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6288 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6289 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6290 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6291 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006292
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006293 Example:
6294 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6295
6296 # applied to:
6297 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6298
6299 # outputs:
6300 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6301
6302 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006303
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006304 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6305
6306 # applied to:
6307 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006308
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006309 # outputs:
6310 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006311
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006312http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6313 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6314
6315 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6316 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006317 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6318 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6319 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006320
6321 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6322 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6323 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6324
6325 Example:
6326 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6327 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6328
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006329 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6330 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6331 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6332 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6333
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006334http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6335 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6336
6337 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6338 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6339 query-string are replaced.
6340
6341 Example:
6342 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6343 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6344
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006345http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6346 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6347
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006348 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6349 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6350 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6351 against.
6352
6353 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6354 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6355 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006356
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006357 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6358 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6359 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6360 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6361 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6362 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6363 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6364 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6365 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006366 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6367 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006368
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006369 Example:
6370 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6371 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006372
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006373 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6374 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006376http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6377 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006378
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006379 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6380 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6381 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6382 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006383
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006384 Example:
6385 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006386
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006387 # applied to:
6388 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006389
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006390 # outputs:
6391 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006392
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006393http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6394 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6395 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006396 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006397 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6398
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006399 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006400 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6401 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006402 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006403 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006404 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006405 are followed to create the response :
6406
6407 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6408 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6409 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6410 ignored.
6411
6412 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6413 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006414 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006415 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6416 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006417
6418 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6419 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6420 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006421 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6422 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006423
6424 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6425 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6426 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006427 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006428 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006429 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006430
6431 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6432 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6433 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6434 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6435 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6436 as a raw content.
6437
6438 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6439 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6440 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6441 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6442 considered as a raw string.
6443
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006444 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006445 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6446 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6447 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6448
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006449 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6450 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006451 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006452
6453 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6454
6455 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006456 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006457 if { path /ping }
6458
6459 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6460 if { path /favicon.ico }
6461
6462 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6463 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6464 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6465
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006466http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6467http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006468
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006469 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6470 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6471 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006472
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006473http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6474 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006475
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006476 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6477 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6478 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6479 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006480
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006481http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006482
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006483 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6484 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6485 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6486 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6487 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006489 Arguments:
6490 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6491 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006493 Example:
6494 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6495 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006497 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6498 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006499
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006500http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006502 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6503 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6504 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006505
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006506 Arguments:
6507 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6508 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006509
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006510 Example:
6511 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6512 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006514 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6515 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6516 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006517
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006518http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006520 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6521 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6522 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6523 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6524 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006526 Example:
6527 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6528 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6529 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6530 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6531 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6532 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6533 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6534 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6535 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006536
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006537http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006538
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006539 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6540 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6541 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6542 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6543 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006544
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006545http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6546 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006548 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6549 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6550 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6551 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6552 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6553 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6554 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6555 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6556 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006557
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006558http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006560 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6561 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6562 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6563 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6564 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6565 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6566 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006568http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006570 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6571 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6572 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006574http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006576 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6577 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6578 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6579 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6580 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6581 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6582 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6583 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006584
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006585http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006587 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6588 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6589 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6590 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6591 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6592 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594 Example :
6595 # prepend the host name before the path
6596 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006597
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006598http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6599
6600 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6601 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6602 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006604http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006606 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6607 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6608 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6609 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6610 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006612http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006614 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6615 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6616 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6617 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6618 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6619 values have higher priority.
6620 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6621 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6622 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6623 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6624 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006628 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6629 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6630 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6631 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6632 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6633 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6634 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006636 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006637
6638 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006639 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6640 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006642http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6643 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6644 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6645 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006646 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6647 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006648
6649 Arguments :
6650 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6651 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006652
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006653 See also "option forwardfor".
6654
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006655 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006656 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6657 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6658
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006659 # After the masking this will track connections
6660 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6661 http-request track-sc0 src
6662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006663 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6664 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6665
6666http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6667
6668 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6669 expression.
6670
6671 Arguments:
6672 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6673 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006674
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006675 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006676 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6677 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6678
6679 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6680 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6681 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6682
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006683http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006684 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6685
6686 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6687 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6688 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6689 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6690 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6691
6692 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6693 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6694 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6695 results.
6696
6697 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006698 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6699 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006700
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006701http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6702
6703 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6704 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6705 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6706 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6707 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6708 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6709 information from the request.
6710
6711 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6712
6713http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6714
6715 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6716 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6717 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6718 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6719 path and the query string.
6720 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6721
6722http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6723
6724 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6725 inline.
6726
6727 Arguments:
6728 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6729 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6730 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6731 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6732 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6733 (request and response)
6734 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6735 processing
6736 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6737 processing
6738 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6739 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6740 and '_'.
6741
6742 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6743 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006744
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006745 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006746 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006748http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6749 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006750
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006751 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6752 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6753 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6754 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6755 agent name must be used.
6756
6757 Arguments:
6758 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6759
6760 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6761 configuration.
6762
6763http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6764
6765 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6766 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6767 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6768 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6769 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6770 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6771 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6772 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6773 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6774 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6775 action.
6776 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6777 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6778 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6779 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6780 you fully understand how it works.
6781
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006782http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6783
6784 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6785 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6786 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6787 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6788 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006789 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006790 processing.
6791
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006792 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006793 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6794 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6795 rules evaluation.
6796
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006797http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6798http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6799 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6800 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6801 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6802 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006803
6804 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6805 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6806 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006807 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6808 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6809 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6810 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6811 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6812 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6813 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6814 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6815 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6816 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006817 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006818 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6819 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6820 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6821 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6822 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006823
6824http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6825http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6826http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6827
6828 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6829 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6830 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6831 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006832 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006833 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6834 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6835 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6836 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6837 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6838 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6839 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6840
6841 Arguments :
6842 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6843 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6844 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6845 select which table entry to update the counters.
6846
6847 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6848 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6849 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6850 that table until the session ends.
6851
6852 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6853 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6854 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6855 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6856 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6857 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6858 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6859 useful information.
6860
6861 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6862 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6863 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6864 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6865 checks that make use of it.
6866
6867http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6868
6869 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006870
6871 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006872 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006873
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006874http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6875
6876 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6877 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6878 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6879 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6880 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6881 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6882
6883 Arguments :
6884 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6885
6886 Example:
6887 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6888
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006889http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6890 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6891
6892 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6893 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6894 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6895 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6896 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6897 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6898 http-buffer-request".
6899
6900 Arguments :
6901
6902 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6903 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6904
6905 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006906 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006907 bytes.
6908
6909 Example:
6910 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6911
6912 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006914http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006915
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006916 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6917 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6918 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006919
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006920
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006921http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006922 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6923
6924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6925 no | yes | yes | yes
6926
6927 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6928 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6929 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6930 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6931 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6932 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6933
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006934 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6935 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006937 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006939 Example:
6940 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006942 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006944 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6945 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006947 Example:
6948 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006950 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006951
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006952 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6953 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006954
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006955 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6956 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006958http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006960 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6961 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6962 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6963 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6964 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6965 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6966 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6967 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006968
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006969http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006971 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6972 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6973 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6974 example, or to pass some internal information.
6975 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6976 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6977 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006979http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006981 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6982 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006983
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006984http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006985
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006986 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006987
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006988http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006989
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006990 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6991 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6992 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6993 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6994 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6995 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6996 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006998 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6999 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7000 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7001 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7002 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007003
7004 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7005 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7006 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7007 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007009http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007010
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007011 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7012 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7013 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7014 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7015 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7016 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007017
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007018http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007019
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007020 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7021 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7022 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7023 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7024 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007025
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007026http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007028 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7029 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7030 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7031 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7032 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7033 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007034
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007035http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7036http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7037 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7038 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7039 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7040 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007041
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007042 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7043 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7044 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007045 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007046 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7047 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7048 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007049 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007050 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007052http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007054 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7055 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7056 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7057 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7058 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7059 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007061http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7062 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007063
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007064 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7065 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007067 Example:
7068 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007070 # applied to:
7071 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007073 # outputs:
7074 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007076 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007078http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7079 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007080
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007081 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007082 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007084 Example:
7085 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007087 # applied to:
7088 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007090 # outputs:
7091 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007092
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007093http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7094 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7095 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007096 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007097 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7098
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007099 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007100 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7101 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007102 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007103 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007104 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007105 are followed to create the response :
7106
7107 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7108 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7109 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7110 ignored.
7111
7112 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7113 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007114 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007115 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7116 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007117
7118 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7119 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7120 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007121 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
7122 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007123
7124 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7125 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7126 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007127 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007128 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007129 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007130
7131 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7132 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7133 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7134 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7135 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7136 as a raw content.
7137
7138 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7139 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7140 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7141 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7142 considered as a raw string.
7143
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007144 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7145 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7146 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7147 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7148
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007149 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7150 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007151 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007152
7153 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7154
7155 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007156 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007157 if { status eq 404 }
7158
7159 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7160 string "This is the end !" \
7161 if { status eq 500 }
7162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007163http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7164http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007165
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007166 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7167 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7168 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007169
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007170http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7171 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007172
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007173 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7174 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7175 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7176 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007177
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007178http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007179
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007180 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7181 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7182 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7183 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7184 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007186 Arguments:
7187 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007189 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7190 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007191
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007192http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007193
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007194 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7195 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7196 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007197
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007198http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7199
7200 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7201 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7202 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7203 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7204 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7205
7206http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7207
7208 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7209 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7210 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7211 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7212 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7213 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7214 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7215 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7216 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7217
7218http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7219
7220 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7221 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7222 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7223 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7224 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7225 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7226 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7227
7228http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7229
7230 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7231 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7232 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7233 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7234 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7235 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7236 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7237 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7238
7239http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7240 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7241
7242 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7243 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7244 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7245 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007246
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007247 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007248 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7249 http-response set-status 431
7250 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7251 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007252
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007253http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007254
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007255 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7256 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7257 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7258 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7259 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7260 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7261 based on some information from the request.
7262
7263 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7264
7265http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7266
7267 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7268 inline.
7269
7270 Arguments:
7271 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7272 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7273 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7274 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7275 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7276 (request and response)
7277 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7278 processing
7279 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7280 processing
7281 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7282 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7283 and '_'.
7284
7285 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7286 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007287
7288 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007289 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007290
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007291http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007292
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007293 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7294 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7295 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7296 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7297 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7298 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7299 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7300 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7301 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7302 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7303 action.
7304 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7305 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7306 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7307 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7308 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007309
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007310http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7311
7312 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7313 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7314 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7315 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7316 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007317 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007318 processing.
7319
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007320 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007321 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007322 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007323 rules evaluation.
7324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007325http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7326http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7327http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007328
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007329 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7330 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7331 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7332 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7333 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7334 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7335
7336http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7337
7338 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7339 about <var-name>.
7340
7341 Example:
7342 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7343
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007344http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7345 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7346
7347 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7348 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7349 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7350 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7351 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7352 buffer is full.
7353
7354 Arguments :
7355
7356 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7357 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7358
7359 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007360 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007361 bytes.
7362
7363 Example:
7364 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007365
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007366http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7367 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7368
7369 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7370 yes | no | yes | yes
7371
7372 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007373 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7374 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7375 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007376
7377 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7378
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007379 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7380 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7381 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7382 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7383 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7384 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7385 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7386 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7387 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7388 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007389
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007390 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7391 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7392 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7393 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7394 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7395 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7396 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007397 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7398 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7399 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7400 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7401 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7402 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007403
7404 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7405 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7406 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7407 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7408 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7409 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7410 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7411 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007412 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007413 downsides of rare connection failures.
7414
7415 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7416 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7417 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7418 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7419 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7420 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007421 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007422 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7423 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7424 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7425 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7426 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7427
7428 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007429 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7430 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7431 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7432 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007433
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007434 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7435 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007436
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007437 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007438
7439 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7440 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7441 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7442
7443 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7444
7445
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007446http-send-name-header [<header>]
7447 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007448 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7449 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007450 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007451 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7452
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007453 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7454 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7455 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7456 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7457 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7458 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7459 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7460 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7461 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7462 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7463 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7464 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7465 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7466 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7467 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7468 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007469
7470 See also : "server"
7471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007472id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007473 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7475 no | yes | yes | yes
7476 Arguments : none
7477
7478 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7479 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7480 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007481
7482
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007483ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7484 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7485 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007486 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007487
7488 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7489 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7490 and running).
7491
7492 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7493 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7494 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007495 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007496 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7497
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007498 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7499 "unless" condition is met.
7500
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007501 Example:
7502 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7503 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7504 ignore-persist if url_static
7505
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007506 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7507
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007508load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7509 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7510 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7511 yes | no | yes | yes
7512
7513 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7514 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7515 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007516 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007517 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7518 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7519 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7520 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7521
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007522 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007523 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007524 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007525
7526 Arguments:
7527 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7528 named "server-state-file".
7529
7530 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7531 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7532 name is used as a file name.
7533
7534 none don't load any stat for this backend
7535
7536 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007537 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7538 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7539 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007540 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007541 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007542
7543 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7544 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7545
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007546 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007547
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007548 global
7549 stats socket /tmp/socket
7550 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007551
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007552 defaults
7553 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007554
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007555 backend bk
7556 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7557 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007558
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007559
7560 Then one can run :
7561
7562 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7563
7564 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7565
7566 1
7567 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7568 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7569 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7570
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007571 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007572
7573 global
7574 stats socket /tmp/socket
7575 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7576
7577 defaults
7578 load-server-state-from-file local
7579
7580 backend bk
7581 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7582 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7583
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007584
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007585 Then one can run :
7586
7587 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7588
7589 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7590
7591 1
7592 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7593 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7594 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7595
7596 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7597 "show servers state"
7598
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007599
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007600log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007601log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007602 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007603no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007604 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7606 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007607
7608 Prefix :
7609 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7610 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7611 prefix does not allow arguments.
7612
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007613 Arguments :
7614 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7615 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7616 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7617 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7618 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7619 parameter.
7620
7621 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7622 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7623
7624 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7625 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7626 standard syslog port).
7627
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007628 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7629 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7630 standard syslog port).
7631
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007632 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7633 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7634 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007635 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007636
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007637 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7638 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7639 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7640 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7641 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7642 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7643 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7644 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7645 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7646 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7647 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7648 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7649 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7650 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7651 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7652 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007653 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7654 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007655
7656 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7657 and "fd@2", see above.
7658
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007659 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7660 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7661 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7662 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7663 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7664 having the logs instantly available.
7665
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007666 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7667 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7668 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7669
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007670 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7671 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007672
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007673 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7674 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7675 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7676 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7677 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7678 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7679 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7680 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7681 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7682 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007683 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007684
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007685 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7686 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7687 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7688 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7689 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7690
7691 <sample_size>
7692 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7693 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7694 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7695 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7696 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7697
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007698 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7699 one of the following :
7700
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007701 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7702 field is stripped. This is the default.
7703 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7704 rfc3164.
7705
7706 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007707 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7708
7709 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7710 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7711
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007712 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7713 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7714 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7715 designed to be used with a local log server.
7716
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007717 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7718 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7719 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7720 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7721 systemd logger consumes.
7722
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007723 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7724 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7725 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7726 used with a local log server.
7727
7728 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7729 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7730 designed to be used with a local log server.
7731
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007732 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7733 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7734 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7735 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7736
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007737 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7738
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007739 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7740 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7741 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7742
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007743 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7744 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7745 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7746 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007747
7748 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7749 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7750 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007751 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7752 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7753 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7754 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7755 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007756
7757 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7758
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007759 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7760 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7761 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007762
7763 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7764 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7765 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7766 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7767
7768 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7769 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007770
7771 Example :
7772 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007773 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7774 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7775 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007776 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007777 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7778 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007779 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007780
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007781
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007782log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007783 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7785 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007786
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007787 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7788 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7789 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7790 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7791 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007792
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007793 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7794 "option httplog" directives.
7795
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007796log-format-sd <string>
7797 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7798 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7799 yes | yes | yes | no
7800
7801 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7802 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7803 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7804 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7805 which covers the log format string in depth.
7806
7807 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7808 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7809
7810 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7811 log format to "rfc5424".
7812
7813 Example :
7814 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7815
7816
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007817log-tag <string>
7818 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7819 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7820 yes | yes | yes | yes
7821
7822 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7823 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7824 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7825 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7826 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7827 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7828 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7829 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7830 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007831
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007832max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7833 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7834 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7835 yes | no | yes | yes
7836
7837 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7838 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7839 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7840 servers.
7841
7842 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7843 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7844 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7845 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7846 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007847 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007848 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7849 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7850 picking a different server.
7851
7852 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7853 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7854 even if they have to be queued.
7855
7856 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7857 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7858
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007859max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7860 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7861 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7862 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007863
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007864maxconn <conns>
7865 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7867 yes | yes | yes | no
7868 Arguments :
7869 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7870 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7871 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7872 closes.
7873
7874 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7875 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7876 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7877 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007878 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7879 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7880 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7881 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007882
7883 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7884 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7885 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7886
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007887 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7888 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007889
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007890 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7891
7892
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007893mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007894 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7896 yes | yes | yes | yes
7897 Arguments :
7898 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7899 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7900 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7901 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7902
7903 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7904 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7905 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7906 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7907 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7908
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007909 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7910 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7911 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007912
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007913 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007914 defaults http_instances
7915 mode http
7916
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007917
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007918monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007919 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7921 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007922 Arguments :
7923 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7924 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007925 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007926 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7927 backend and its backup.
7928
7929 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7930 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7931 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7932 servers in a list of backends.
7933
7934 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7935 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7936 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7937 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7938 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7939 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7940 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007941 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7942 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007943
7944 Example:
7945 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007946 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007947 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7948 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7949 monitor-uri /site_alive
7950 monitor fail if site_dead
7951
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007952 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007953
7954
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007955monitor-uri <uri>
7956 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7958 yes | yes | yes | no
7959 Arguments :
7960 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7961 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7962
7963 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7964 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7965 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7966 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7967 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7968 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7969 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7970 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7971
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007972 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007973 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7974 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7975 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7976 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7977 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7978 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007979
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007980 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7981 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7982 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7983 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7984
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007985 Example :
7986 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7987 frontend www
7988 mode http
7989 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7990
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007991 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007992
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007993
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007994option abortonclose
7995no option abortonclose
7996 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7998 yes | no | yes | yes
7999 Arguments : none
8000
8001 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8002 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8003 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8004 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008005 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008006 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8007 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8008 encountered while delivering the response.
8009
8010 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8011 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8012 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8013 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8014 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8015 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008016 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008017 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008018 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008019 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8020 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8021 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8022
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008023 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8024 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008025 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8026 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8027 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8028 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8029 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8030 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008031 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008032
8033 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8034 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8035
8036 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8037
8038
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008039option accept-invalid-http-request
8040no option accept-invalid-http-request
8041 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8043 yes | yes | yes | no
8044 Arguments : none
8045
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008046 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008047 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008048 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008049 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8050 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8051 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8052 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8053 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008054 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8055 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8056 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8057 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008058 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008059 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008060 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8061 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8062 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008063
8064 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8065 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8066 been confirmed.
8067
8068 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8069 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008070 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8071 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008072 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8073
8074 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8075 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8076
8077 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8078 stats socket.
8079
8080
8081option accept-invalid-http-response
8082no option accept-invalid-http-response
8083 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8085 yes | no | yes | yes
8086 Arguments : none
8087
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008088 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008089 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008090 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008091 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8092 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8093 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8094 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8095 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008096 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8097 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8098 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008099
8100 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8101 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8102 been confirmed.
8103
8104 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8105 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8106 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8107 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8108
8109 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8110 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8111
8112 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8113 stats socket.
8114
8115
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008116option allbackups
8117no option allbackups
8118 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8120 yes | no | yes | yes
8121 Arguments : none
8122
8123 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8124 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8125 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8126 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8127 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8128 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8129 order between the backup servers anymore.
8130
8131 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8132 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8133
8134 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8135 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8136
8137
8138option checkcache
8139no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008140 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8142 yes | no | yes | yes
8143 Arguments : none
8144
8145 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8146 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008147 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008148 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8149 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008150 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008151
8152 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008153 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008154 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008155 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8156 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008157 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008158 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008159 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8160 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008161 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008162 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8163 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008164 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008165 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8166 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8167 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8168 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8169 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8170 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8171 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8172 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8173 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8174
8175 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008176 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8177 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8178 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8179 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008180
8181 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8182 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008183 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008184 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008185
8186 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8187 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8188
8189
8190option clitcpka
8191no option clitcpka
8192 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8194 yes | yes | yes | no
8195 Arguments : none
8196
8197 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8198 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008199 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008200 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8201
8202 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8203 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8204 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8205 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8206
8207 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8208 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8209 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8210 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8211 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8212
8213 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8214
8215 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8216 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8217 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8218
8219 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8220 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8221
8222 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8223
8224
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008225option contstats
8226 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8228 yes | yes | yes | no
8229 Arguments : none
8230
8231 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8232 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8233 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8234 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008235 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8236 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8237 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8238 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8239 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008240
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008241option disable-h2-upgrade
8242no option disable-h2-upgrade
8243 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8244 connection.
8245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8246 yes | yes | yes | no
8247 Arguments : none
8248
8249 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8250 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8251 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8252 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008253 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8254 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8255 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8256 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8257 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8258 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008259
8260 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8261 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008262
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008263option dontlog-normal
8264no option dontlog-normal
8265 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8267 yes | yes | yes | no
8268 Arguments : none
8269
8270 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8271 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8272 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8273 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8274 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8275 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8276 logged.
8277
8278 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8279 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8280 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008282 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008283 logging.
8284
8285
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008286option dontlognull
8287no option dontlognull
8288 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8290 yes | yes | yes | no
8291 Arguments : none
8292
8293 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8294 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8295 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8296 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8297 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8298 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008299 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8300 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8301 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008302
8303 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008304 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008305 would not be logged.
8306
8307 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8308 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8309
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008310 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008311 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008312
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008313
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008314option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008315 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8317 yes | yes | yes | yes
8318 Arguments :
8319 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8320 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008321 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008322 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008323
8324 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8325 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8326 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8327 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8328 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8329 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8330 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008331 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8332 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8333 possible that the client has already brought one.
8334
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008335 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008336 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008337 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008338 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008339 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008340 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008341
8342 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8343 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8344 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8345 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8346 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8347 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008348 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008349
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008350 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8351 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8352 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8353 are under the control of the end-user.
8354
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008355 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008356 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8357 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008358 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8359 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8360 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008361
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008362 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008363 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8364 frontend www
8365 mode http
8366 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8367
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008368 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8369 backend www
8370 mode http
8371 option forwardfor header X-Client
8372
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008373 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008374 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008375
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008376
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008377option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8378no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8379 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8381 yes | yes | yes | no
8382 Arguments : none
8383
8384 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8385 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8386 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8387 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8388 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8389 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8390 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8391
8392 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8393 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8394 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8395 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8396 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8397 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8398 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8399 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8400 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8401 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8402
8403 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8404
8405 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8406 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8407
8408 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8409 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8410
8411
8412option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8413no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8414 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8416 yes | no | yes | yes
8417 Arguments : none
8418
8419 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8420 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8421 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8422 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8423 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8424 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8425 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8426
8427 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8428 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8429 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8430 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8431 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8432 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8433 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8434 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8435 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8436 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8437
8438 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8439
8440 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8441 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8442
8443 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8444 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8445
8446
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008447option http-buffer-request
8448no option http-buffer-request
8449 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8451 yes | yes | yes | yes
8452 Arguments : none
8453
8454 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8455 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8456 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8457 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8458 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8459 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008460 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8461 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8462 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8463 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008464
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008465 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8466 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008467
8468
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008469option http-ignore-probes
8470no option http-ignore-probes
8471 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8473 yes | yes | yes | no
8474 Arguments : none
8475
8476 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8477 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8478 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8479 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8480 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8481 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8482 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8483 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8484 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008485 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8486 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008487 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8488
8489 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8490 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8491 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8492 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8493 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8494 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8495 are often the only way to detect them.
8496
8497 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8498 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8499
8500 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8501
8502
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008503option http-keep-alive
8504no option http-keep-alive
8505 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8507 yes | yes | yes | yes
8508 Arguments : none
8509
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008510 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8511 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008512 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8513 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008514 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8515 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8516 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008517
8518 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8519 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008520 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8521 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8522 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8523 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8524 situations where this option may be useful :
8525
8526 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008527 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008528
8529 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8530 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8531
8532 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8533 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8534 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8535 request.
8536
8537 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8538 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008539 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8540 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8541 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008542
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008543 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8544 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8545 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8546 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8547 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8548 not set.
8549
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008550 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8551 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8552 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008553
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008554 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008555 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008556 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008557
8558
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008559option http-no-delay
8560no option http-no-delay
8561 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8563 yes | yes | yes | yes
8564 Arguments : none
8565
8566 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8567 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8568 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8569 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8570 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8571 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8572 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8573 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8574 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8575 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8576 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8577 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8578 affected.
8579
8580 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8581 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8582 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8583 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8584 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8585 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8586 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8587 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8588 latency environments.
8589
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008590 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8591
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008592
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008593option http-pretend-keepalive
8594no option http-pretend-keepalive
8595 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008597 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008598 Arguments : none
8599
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008600 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008601 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8602 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8603 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8604 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8605 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8606 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8607 consider the response complete.
8608
8609 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8610 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8611 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8612 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008613 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008614 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8615
8616 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8617 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8618 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8619 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8620 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8621 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8622 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8623
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008624 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8625 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8626 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8627 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8628 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8629 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008630
8631 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8632 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8633
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008634 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008635 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008636
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008637
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008638option http-server-close
8639no option http-server-close
8640 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8642 yes | yes | yes | yes
8643 Arguments : none
8644
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008645 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8646 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8647 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8648 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008649 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8650 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8651 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8652 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8653 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8654 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8655 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8656 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8657 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8658 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8659 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008660
8661 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8662 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8663 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8664 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008665 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8666 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008667
8668 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8669 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008670 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8671 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8672 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008673
8674 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8675 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8676
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008677 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8678 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008679
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008680option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008681no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008682 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8684 yes | yes | yes | no
8685 Arguments : none
8686
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008687 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008688 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8689 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8690 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8691 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8692 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8693 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8694
8695 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8696 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008697 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8698 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8699 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008700
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008701 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8702 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8703 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8704 front of an existing proxy.
8705
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008706 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8707
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008708 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008709
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008710option httpchk
8711option httpchk <uri>
8712option httpchk <method> <uri>
8713option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008714 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8716 yes | no | yes | yes
8717 Arguments :
8718 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8719 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8720 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8721 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8722 ones.
8723
8724 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8725 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8726 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8727
8728 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8729 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8730 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008731 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008732
8733 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8734 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8735 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8736 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8737 the lack of any response.
8738
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008739 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8740 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8741 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8742 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8743
8744 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8745 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8746 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008747
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008748 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8749 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008750 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008751 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008752 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008753
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008754 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8755 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8756 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8757 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8758
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008759 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008760 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8761 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8762 backend https_relay
8763 mode tcp
8764 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8765 http-check send hdr Host www
8766 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008767
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008768 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8769 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8770 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008771
8772
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008773option httpclose
8774no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008775 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8777 yes | yes | yes | yes
8778 Arguments : none
8779
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008780 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8781 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8782 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8783 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008784 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008785
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008786 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8787 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008788 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008789 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8790 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008791
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008792 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8793 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8794 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008795
8796 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8797 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008798 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8799 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8800 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008801
8802 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8803 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8804
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008805 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008806
8807
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008808option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008809 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008811 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008812 Arguments :
8813 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8814 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8815 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008816 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008817 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008818
8819 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8820 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8821 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8822 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8823 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8824 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8825 ports.
8826
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008827 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8828 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008829
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008830 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008832 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008833
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008834
8835option http_proxy
8836no option http_proxy
8837 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8839 yes | yes | yes | yes
8840 Arguments : none
8841
8842 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8843 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8844 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8845 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8846 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8847
8848 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8849 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008850 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8851 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008852
8853 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8854 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8855
8856 Example :
8857 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8858 backend direct_forward
8859 option httpclose
8860 option http_proxy
8861
8862 See also : "option httpclose"
8863
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008864
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008865option independent-streams
8866no option independent-streams
8867 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8869 yes | yes | yes | yes
8870 Arguments : none
8871
8872 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8873 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8874 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8875 receive data or not.
8876
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008877 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008878 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8879 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8880 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8881 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8882 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8883 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8884 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8885 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8886 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8887 socket buffers.
8888
8889 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8890 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8891 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8892 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8893 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8894
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008895 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008896
8897
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008898option ldap-check
8899 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8901 yes | no | yes | yes
8902 Arguments : none
8903
8904 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8905 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8906 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8907 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8908
8909 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8910 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8911
8912 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8913 configure it.
8914
8915 Example :
8916 option ldap-check
8917
8918 See also : "option httpchk"
8919
8920
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008921option external-check
8922 Use external processes for server health checks
8923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8924 yes | no | yes | yes
8925
8926 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8927 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8928 command".
8929
8930 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8931
8932 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8933
8934
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008935option log-health-checks
8936no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008937 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8939 yes | no | yes | yes
8940 Arguments : none
8941
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008942 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8943 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8944 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008945
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008946 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8947 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8948 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8949 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8950 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8951
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008952 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008953 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008954
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008955 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8956 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8957 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008958
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008959
8960option log-separate-errors
8961no option log-separate-errors
8962 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8964 yes | yes | yes | no
8965 Arguments : none
8966
8967 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8968 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8969 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8970 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8971 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8972 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8973 provides very important information.
8974
8975 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8976 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8977 error logs.
8978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008979 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008980 logging.
8981
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008982
8983option logasap
8984no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008985 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8987 yes | yes | yes | no
8988 Arguments : none
8989
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008990 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8991 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8992 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8993 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8994
8995 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8996 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8997 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8998 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8999 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009000 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009001 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9002 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9003 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9004 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009005 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009006
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009007 Examples :
9008 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9009 mode http
9010 option httplog
9011 option logasap
9012 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9013
9014 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9015 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9016 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9017 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009019 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009020 logging.
9021
9022
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009023option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009024 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9026 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009027 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009028 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9029 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009030 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9031 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009032
9033 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9034 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009035 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009036 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
9037 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
9038 in the MySQL table, like this :
9039
9040 USE mysql;
9041 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
9042 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
9043
9044 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009045 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009046 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9047 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9048 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9049 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9050 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9051 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9052 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9053
9054 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9055 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009056
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009057 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009058
9059 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9060 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9061 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9062 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009063 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
9064 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009065
9066 See also: "option httpchk"
9067
9068
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009069option nolinger
9070no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009071 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009072 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9073 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009074 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009075
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009076 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009077 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9078 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9079 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9080 connections.
9081
9082 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9083 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009084 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9085 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9086 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9087 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9088 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9089 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9090 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9091 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9092 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9093 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9094 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9095 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9096 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009097
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009098 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9099 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9100 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9101 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9102 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009103
9104 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9105 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009106 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009107 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009108 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009109
9110 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9111 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9112
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009113 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9114 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009115
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009116option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9117 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9119 yes | yes | yes | yes
9120 Arguments :
9121 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9122 matching <network>
9123 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9124 header name.
9125
9126 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9127 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9128 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9129 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9130 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9131 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9132 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9133 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9134 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9135 possible that the client has already brought one.
9136
9137 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9138 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9139 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9140 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9141 header and requires different one.
9142
9143 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9144 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9145 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009146 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9147 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9148 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9149 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9150 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009151
9152 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9153 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9154 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9155 both are defined.
9156
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009157 Examples :
9158 # Original Destination address
9159 frontend www
9160 mode http
9161 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9162
9163 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9164 backend www
9165 mode http
9166 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9167
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009168 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009169
9170
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009171option persist
9172no option persist
9173 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9174 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9175 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009176 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009177
9178 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9179 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9180 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9181 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9182 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9183 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9184 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9185 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9186 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9187 redirected to another valid server.
9188
9189 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9190 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9191
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009192 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009193
9194
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009195option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9196 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9198 yes | no | yes | yes
9199 Arguments :
9200 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9201 PostgreSQL server.
9202
9203 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9204 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9205 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9206 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9207
9208 See also: "option httpchk"
9209
9210
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009211option prefer-last-server
9212no option prefer-last-server
9213 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9214 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9215 yes | no | yes | yes
9216 Arguments : none
9217
9218 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
9219 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
9220 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9221 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9222 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9223 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9224 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9225 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9226 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009227 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9228 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009229 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9230 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9231 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009232 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9233 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9234 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009235
9236 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9237 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9238
9239 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9240
9241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009242option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009243option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009244no option redispatch
9245 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9247 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009248 Arguments :
9249 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9250 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9251 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009252 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009253 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009254 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009255 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9256 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9257 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9258
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009259
9260 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9261 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9262 be able to access the service anymore.
9263
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009264 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9265 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009266
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009267 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9268 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9269 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9270 following order:
9271
9272 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9273
9274 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9275 list, or
9276
9277 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9278
9279 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9280 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9281
9282 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9283 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9284 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9285 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9286
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009287 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009288 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9289 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009291 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9292 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9293
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009294 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009295
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009296
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009297option redis-check
9298 Use redis health checks for server testing
9299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9300 yes | no | yes | yes
9301 Arguments : none
9302
9303 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9304 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9305 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9306 find the "+PONG" response message.
9307
9308 Example :
9309 option redis-check
9310
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009311 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009312
9313
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009314option smtpchk
9315option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9316 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9318 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009319 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009320 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009321 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009322 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9323
9324 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9325 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9326 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9327
9328 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9329 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9330 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9331 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9332 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9333 dead server.
9334
9335 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9336 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009337 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009338 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9339
9340 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9341 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9342 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9343 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009344 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009345
9346 Example :
9347 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9348
9349 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009351
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009352option socket-stats
9353no option socket-stats
9354
9355 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9357 yes | yes | yes | no
9358
9359 Arguments : none
9360
9361
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009362option splice-auto
9363no option splice-auto
9364 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9366 yes | yes | yes | yes
9367 Arguments : none
9368
9369 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9370 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009371 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009372 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009373 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009374 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9375 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9376 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9377 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9378
9379 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9380 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9381 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9382 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9383 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9384 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9385 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9386 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9387 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9388 keyword.
9389
9390 Example :
9391 option splice-auto
9392
9393 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9394 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9395
9396 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9397 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9398
9399
9400option splice-request
9401no option splice-request
9402 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9404 yes | yes | yes | yes
9405 Arguments : none
9406
9407 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009408 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009409 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9410 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9411 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9412 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9413
9414 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9415
9416 Example :
9417 option splice-request
9418
9419 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9420 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9421
9422 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9423 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9424
9425
9426option splice-response
9427no option splice-response
9428 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9430 yes | yes | yes | yes
9431 Arguments : none
9432
9433 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009434 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009435 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9436 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9437 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9438 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9439
9440 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9441
9442 Example :
9443 option splice-response
9444
9445 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9446 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9447
9448 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9449 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9450
9451
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009452option spop-check
9453 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9455 no | no | no | yes
9456 Arguments : none
9457
9458 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9459 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9460 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9461 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9462
9463 Example :
9464 option spop-check
9465
9466 See also : "option httpchk"
9467
9468
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009469option srvtcpka
9470no option srvtcpka
9471 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9473 yes | no | yes | yes
9474 Arguments : none
9475
9476 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9477 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009478 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009479 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9480
9481 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9482 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9483 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9484 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9485
9486 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9487 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9488 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9489 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9490 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9491
9492 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9493
9494 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9495 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9496 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9497
9498 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9499 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9500
9501 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9502
9503
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009504option ssl-hello-chk
9505 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9507 yes | no | yes | yes
9508 Arguments : none
9509
9510 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9511 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9512 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9513 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9514 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9515 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9516 hello message.
9517
9518 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9519 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9520 messages, which is appreciable.
9521
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009522 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9523 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9524 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009525
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009526 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9527
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009528
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009529option tcp-check
9530 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9531 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9532 yes | no | yes | yes
9533
9534 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9535 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9536
9537 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9538 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9539 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9540
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009541 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009542 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9543 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9544 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9545 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9546 only.
9547
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009548 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009549 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9550 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9551 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9552 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9553
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009554 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009555 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9556 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009557 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009558 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9559 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9560 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9561 the respective protocols.
9562 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009563 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009564
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009565 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009566
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009567 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9568 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9569 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9570 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009571
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009572 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9573 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9574 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009575
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009576
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009577 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009578 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009579 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009580 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009581
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009582 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009583 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009584 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009585
9586 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9587 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009588 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009589 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009590 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009591 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009592 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009593 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009594 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9595 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009596 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009597 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9598 tcp-check expect string +OK
9599
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009600 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009601 (send many headers before analyzing)
9602 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009603 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009604 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9605 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9606 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9607 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009608 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009609
9610
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009611 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009612
9613
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009614option tcp-smart-accept
9615no option tcp-smart-accept
9616 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9618 yes | yes | yes | no
9619 Arguments : none
9620
9621 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9622 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9623 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9624 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9625 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9626 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9627
9628 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9629 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9630 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9631 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9632
9633 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9634 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9635 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009636 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009637
9638 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9639 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9640 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9641
9642 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9643 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9644 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9645
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009646 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9647
9648
9649option tcp-smart-connect
9650no option tcp-smart-connect
9651 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9653 yes | no | yes | yes
9654 Arguments : none
9655
9656 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9657 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9658 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9659 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9660 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9661
9662 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9663 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9664 complex.
9665
9666 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9667 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9668 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9669
9670 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9671 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9672
9673 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9674
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009675
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009676option tcpka
9677 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9679 yes | yes | yes | yes
9680 Arguments : none
9681
9682 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9683 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009684 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009685 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9686
9687 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9688 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9689 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9690 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9691
9692 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9693 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9694 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9695 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9696 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9697
9698 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9699
9700 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9701 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9702 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9703 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9704 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9705 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9706 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9707 backends.
9708
9709 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9710
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009711
9712option tcplog
9713 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009715 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009716 Arguments : none
9717
9718 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9719 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9720 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9721 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9722 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9723 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9724 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9725 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9726
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009727 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009729 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009730
9731
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009732option transparent
9733no option transparent
9734 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009736 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009737 Arguments : none
9738
9739 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9740 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9741 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9742 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9743 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9744 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9745 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9746 appropriate server.
9747
9748 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9749 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9750
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009751 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009752 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009753
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009754
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009755external-check command <command>
9756 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9758 yes | no | yes | yes
9759
9760 Arguments :
9761 <command> is the external command to run
9762
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009763 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9764
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009765 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009766
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009767 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9768 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9769 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9770 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9771 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9772 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009773
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009774 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9775
9776 Environment variables :
9777 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9778 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9779
9780 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9781
9782 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9783
9784 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9785 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9786 for a UNIX socket).
9787
9788 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9789
9790 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9791
9792 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9793
9794 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9795
9796 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9797
9798 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9799 socket).
9800
9801 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9802 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9803
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009804 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9805
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009806 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9807 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9808 failed.
9809
9810 Example :
9811 external-check command /bin/true
9812
9813 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9814
9815
9816external-check path <path>
9817 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9819 yes | no | yes | yes
9820
9821 Arguments :
9822 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9823
9824 The default path is "".
9825
9826 Example :
9827 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9828
9829 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9830 "external-check command"
9831
9832
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009833persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009834persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009835 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9837 yes | no | yes | yes
9838 Arguments :
9839 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009840 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9841 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009842
9843 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9844 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009845 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009846 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9847 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9848 forwarded to this server.
9849
9850 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9851 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9852 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009853 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009854 a single "listen" section.
9855
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009856 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9857 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9858 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9859
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009860 Example :
9861 listen tse-farm
9862 bind :3389
9863 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9864 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9865 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9866 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9867 persist rdp-cookie
9868 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009869 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009870 balance rdp-cookie
9871 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9872 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9873
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009874 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9875 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009876
9877
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009878rate-limit sessions <rate>
9879 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9881 yes | yes | yes | no
9882 Arguments :
9883 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9884 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9885
9886 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9887 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9888 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9889 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9890 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9891 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9892
9893 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9894 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9895 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9896 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9897
9898 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9899 listen smtp
9900 mode tcp
9901 bind :25
9902 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009903 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009904
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009905 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9906 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9907 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009908
9909 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9910
9911
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009912redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9913redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9914redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009915 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9917 no | yes | yes | yes
9918
9919 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009920 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009921
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009922 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009923 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009924 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9925 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9926 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009927
9928 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9929 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9930 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9931 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9932 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009933 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9934 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9935 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9936 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009937
9938 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9939 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9940 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9941 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9942 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9943 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009944 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009945 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009946 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9947 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9948 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009949
9950 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009951 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9952 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9953 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009954 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009955 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9956 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9957 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9958 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009959
9960 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009961 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009962
9963 - "drop-query"
9964 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9965 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9966 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9967 with a location-type redirect.
9968
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009969 - "append-slash"
9970 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9971 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9972 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9973 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9974
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009975 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9976 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9977 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9978 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9979 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9980 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9981 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9982
9983 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9984 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9985 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9986 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9987 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9988 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9989 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009990
9991 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9992 acl clear dst_port 80
9993 acl secure dst_port 8080
9994 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009995 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009996 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009997 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9998
9999 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010000 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10001 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10002 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010003 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010004
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010005 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10006 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10007 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10008
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010009 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010010 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010011
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010012 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010013 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10014 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10015 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010017 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010018
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010019
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010020retries <value>
10021 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10022 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10023 yes | no | yes | yes
10024 Arguments :
10025 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10026 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10027 default value is 3.
10028
10029 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10030 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10031 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10032
10033 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010034 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10035 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010036
10037 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10038 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10039
10040 See also : "option redispatch"
10041
10042
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010043retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010044 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10045 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10046 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010047 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10048 yes | no | yes | yes
10049 Arguments :
10050 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10051 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10052 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10053 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10054
10055 none never retry
10056
10057 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10058 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10059
10060 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10061 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10062 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10063 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10064 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10065 processing the request.
10066
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010067 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10068 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10069 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10070 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10071 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10072 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10073 overflow attack for example).
10074
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010075 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10076 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10077 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10078 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10079 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10080 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10081 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10082 amplify denial of service attacks.
10083
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010084 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10085 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10086 considered to be safe to retry.
10087
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010088 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10089 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10090 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10091 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10092 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010093
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010094 all-retryable-errors
10095 retry request for any error that are considered
10096 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10097 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10098 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10099
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010100 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10101 not cumulative.
10102
10103 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10104 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10105 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10106 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10107
10108 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10109 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10110 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10111 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10112 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10113 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10114 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10115 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10116 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10117 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10118 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10119 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10120
10121 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10122 should not use this directive.
10123
10124 The default is "conn-failure".
10125
10126 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10127
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010128server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010129 Declare a server in a backend
10130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10131 no | no | yes | yes
10132 Arguments :
10133 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010134 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010135 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010136
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010137 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10138 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10139 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10140 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010141 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10142 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
10143 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
10144 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10145 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010146 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10147 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10148 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10149 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10150 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10151 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10152 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010153 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010154 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10155 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10156 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10157 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10158 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10159 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010160 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10161 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010162 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10163 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010164
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010165 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010166 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10167 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10168 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10169 adding this value to the client's port.
10170
10171 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10172 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010173 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010174
10175 Examples :
10176 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10177 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010178 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010179 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10180 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10181 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010182
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010183 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10184 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10185 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10186 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10187 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10188
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010189 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10190 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010191
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010192server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010193 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010194 this backend.
10195 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10196 no | no | yes | yes
10197
10198 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10199 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10200 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10201 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10202 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010203
10204 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10205 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10206
10207 global
10208 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10209
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010210 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010211 load-server-state-from-file
10212
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010213 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010214 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010215
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010216server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10217 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10218 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10220 no | no | yes | yes
10221
10222 Arguments:
10223 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10224
10225 <num | range>
10226 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10227 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10228 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10229 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10230
10231 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10232
10233 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10234
10235 <params*>
10236 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10237 keyword.
10238
10239 Examples:
10240 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10241 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10242 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10243
10244 # or
10245 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10246
10247 # would be equivalent to:
10248 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10249 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10250 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10251
10252
10253
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010254source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010255source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010256source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010257 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10259 yes | no | yes | yes
10260 Arguments :
10261 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10262 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010263
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010264 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010265 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10266 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10267 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10268 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10269 supported prefixes are :
10270 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10271 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10272 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010273 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010274 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10275 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010276
10277 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10278 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010279 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10280 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10281 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010282
10283 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10284 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10285 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10286 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10287 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10288 <addr>.
10289
10290 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10291 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10292 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10293 port.
10294
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010295 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10296 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10297 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10298 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010299 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010300 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10301 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10302 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10303 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10304 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10305 HTTP header.
10306
10307 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10308 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010309 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010310 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10311 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10312 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10313 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10314 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10315 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10316 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10317
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010318 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10319 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10320 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10321 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10322 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10323 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10324
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010325 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10326 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10327 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10328 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10329
10330 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10331 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10332 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10333 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10334 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10335 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10336
10337 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10338 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10339 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10340 there are two methods :
10341
10342 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10343 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10344 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10345 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10346 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10347 of the client ranges may be used.
10348
10349 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10350 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10351 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10352 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10353 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10354 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10355 same session.
10356
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010357 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10358 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10359 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010360 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010361
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010362 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10363
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010364 Examples :
10365 backend private
10366 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10367 source 192.168.1.200
10368
10369 backend transparent_ssl1
10370 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10371 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10372
10373 backend transparent_ssl2
10374 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10375 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10376 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10377
10378 backend transparent_ssl3
10379 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10380 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10381 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10382
10383 backend transparent_smtp
10384 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10385 # with Tproxy version 4.
10386 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10387
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010388 backend transparent_http
10389 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10390 # proxy.
10391 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10392
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010393 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010394 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10395
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010396
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010397srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10398 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10399 the connection on the server side.
10400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10401 yes | no | yes | yes
10402 Arguments :
10403 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10404
10405 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10406 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010407 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10408 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010409
10410 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10411
10412
10413srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10414 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10415 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10416 server side.
10417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10418 yes | no | yes | yes
10419 Arguments :
10420 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10421 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10422 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10423 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10424
10425 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10426 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010427 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10428 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010429
10430 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10431
10432
10433srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10434 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10436 yes | no | yes | yes
10437 Arguments :
10438 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10439 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10440 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10441 document.
10442
10443 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10444 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010445 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10446 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010447
10448 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10449
10450
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010451stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10452 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010454 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010455
10456 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10457 matched.
10458
10459 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10460 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10461
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010462 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10463 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010464 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010465
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010466 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10467 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10468 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10469 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010470
10471 Example :
10472 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10473 backend stats_localhost
10474 stats enable
10475 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10476
10477 Example :
10478 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10479 backend stats_auth
10480 stats enable
10481 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10482 stats admin if TRUE
10483
10484 Example :
10485 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10486 userlist stats-auth
10487 group admin users admin
10488 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10489 group readonly users haproxy
10490 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10491
10492 backend stats_auth
10493 stats enable
10494 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10495 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10496 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10497 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10498
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010499 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10500 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10501 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010502
10503
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010504stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10505 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010507 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010508 Arguments :
10509 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10510
10511 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10512
10513 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10514 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10515 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10516 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10517 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10518 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10519
10520 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10521 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10522 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010523 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010524
10525 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10526 report using "stats scope".
10527
10528 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10529 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10530 unobvious parameters.
10531
10532 Example :
10533 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10534 backend public_www
10535 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10536 stats enable
10537 stats hide-version
10538 stats scope .
10539 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010540 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010541 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10542 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10543
10544 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10545 backend private_monitoring
10546 stats enable
10547 stats uri /admin?stats
10548 stats refresh 5s
10549
10550 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10551
10552
10553stats enable
10554 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010556 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010557 Arguments : none
10558
10559 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10560 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10561 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10562 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10563 - stats auth : no authentication
10564 - stats scope : no restriction
10565
10566 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10567 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10568 unobvious parameters.
10569
10570 Example :
10571 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10572 backend public_www
10573 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10574 stats enable
10575 stats hide-version
10576 stats scope .
10577 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010578 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010579 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10580 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10581
10582 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10583 backend private_monitoring
10584 stats enable
10585 stats uri /admin?stats
10586 stats refresh 5s
10587
10588 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10589
10590
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010591stats hide-version
10592 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010594 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010595 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010596
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010597 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10598 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10599 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10600 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10601 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10602 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010604 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10605 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10606 unobvious parameters.
10607
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010608 Example :
10609 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10610 backend public_www
10611 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010612 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010613 stats hide-version
10614 stats scope .
10615 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010616 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010617 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10618 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010619
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010620 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10621 backend private_monitoring
10622 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010623 stats uri /admin?stats
10624 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010625
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010626 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010627
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010628
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010629stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10630 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10631 Access control for statistics
10632
10633 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10634 no | no | yes | yes
10635
10636 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10637 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10638 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10639 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10640 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10641 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10642
10643 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10644 instance.
10645
10646 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10647 about ACL usage.
10648
10649
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010650stats realm <realm>
10651 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010653 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010654 Arguments :
10655 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10656 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10657 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10658
10659 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10660 using a backslash ('\').
10661
10662 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10663 only related to authentication.
10664
10665 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10666 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10667 unobvious parameters.
10668
10669 Example :
10670 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10671 backend public_www
10672 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10673 stats enable
10674 stats hide-version
10675 stats scope .
10676 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010677 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010678 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10679 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10680
10681 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10682 backend private_monitoring
10683 stats enable
10684 stats uri /admin?stats
10685 stats refresh 5s
10686
10687 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10688
10689
10690stats refresh <delay>
10691 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010693 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010694 Arguments :
10695 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10696 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10697 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10698 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10699 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10700 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10701
10702 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10703 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10704 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010705 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010706
10707 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10708 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10709 unobvious parameters.
10710
10711 Example :
10712 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10713 backend public_www
10714 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10715 stats enable
10716 stats hide-version
10717 stats scope .
10718 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010719 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010720 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10721 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10722
10723 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10724 backend private_monitoring
10725 stats enable
10726 stats uri /admin?stats
10727 stats refresh 5s
10728
10729 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10730
10731
10732stats scope { <name> | "." }
10733 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010735 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010736 Arguments :
10737 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10738 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10739 section in which the statement appears.
10740
10741 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10742 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10743 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10744 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10745 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10746 exists.
10747
10748 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10749 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10750 unobvious parameters.
10751
10752 Example :
10753 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10754 backend public_www
10755 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10756 stats enable
10757 stats hide-version
10758 stats scope .
10759 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010760 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010761 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10762 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10763
10764 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10765 backend private_monitoring
10766 stats enable
10767 stats uri /admin?stats
10768 stats refresh 5s
10769
10770 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10771
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010772
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010773stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010774 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010776 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010777
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010778 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010779 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10780
10781 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10782 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10783
10784 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10785 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010786 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010787
10788 Example :
10789 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10790 backend private_monitoring
10791 stats enable
10792 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10793 stats uri /admin?stats
10794 stats refresh 5s
10795
10796 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10797 global section.
10798
10799
10800stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010801 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10803 yes | yes | yes | yes
10804 Arguments : none
10805
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010806 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010807 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10808 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10809 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10810 - IP (socket, server)
10811 - cookie (backend, server)
10812
10813 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10814 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010815 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010816
10817 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10818
10819
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010820stats show-modules
10821 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10823 yes | yes | yes | yes
10824 Arguments : none
10825
10826 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10827 values as a tooltip.
10828
10829 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10830 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10831 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10832
10833 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10834
10835
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010836stats show-node [ <name> ]
10837 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010839 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010840 Arguments:
10841 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10842 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10843
10844 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10845 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010846 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010847
10848 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10849 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10850 unobvious parameters.
10851
10852 Example:
10853 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10854 backend private_monitoring
10855 stats enable
10856 stats show-node Europe-1
10857 stats uri /admin?stats
10858 stats refresh 5s
10859
10860 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10861 section.
10862
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010863
10864stats uri <prefix>
10865 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010867 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010868 Arguments :
10869 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10870 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10871 query string.
10872
10873 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10874 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10875 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10876 possible to reach it in the application.
10877
10878 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010879 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010880 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10881 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10882 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10883 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10884
10885 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10886 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10887 an address or a port to statistics only.
10888
10889 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10890 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10891 unobvious parameters.
10892
10893 Example :
10894 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10895 backend public_www
10896 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10897 stats enable
10898 stats hide-version
10899 stats scope .
10900 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010901 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010902 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10903 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10904
10905 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10906 backend private_monitoring
10907 stats enable
10908 stats uri /admin?stats
10909 stats refresh 5s
10910
10911 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10912
10913
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010914stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10915 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010917 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010918
10919 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010920 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010921 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010922 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010923 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10924
10925 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10926 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10927 the "stick-table" statement.
10928
10929 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10930 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10931 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10932 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10933 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10934
10935 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10936 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10937 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10938 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10939 transformation rules.
10940
10941 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10942 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10943 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10944 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10945 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10946 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10947 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10948
10949 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10950 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10951 ACL based conditions.
10952
10953 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10954 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10955 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10956 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10957
10958 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10959 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10960 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10961 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10962
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010963 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10964 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010965 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010966
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010967 Example :
10968 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10969 # last 30 minutes
10970 backend pop
10971 mode tcp
10972 balance roundrobin
10973 stick store-request src
10974 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10975 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10976 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10977
10978 backend smtp
10979 mode tcp
10980 balance roundrobin
10981 stick match src table pop
10982 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10983 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10984
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010985 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010986 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010987
10988
10989stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10990 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10992 no | no | yes | yes
10993
10994 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10995 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10996 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10997 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10998
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010999 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11000 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011001 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011002
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011003 Examples :
11004 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011005 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011006
11007 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11008 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11009 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11010
11011
11012 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11013 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11014 backend http
11015 mode http
11016 balance roundrobin
11017 stick on src table https
11018 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11019 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11020 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11021
11022 backend https
11023 mode tcp
11024 balance roundrobin
11025 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11026 stick on src
11027 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11028 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11029
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011030 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011031
11032
11033stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11034 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11036 no | no | yes | yes
11037
11038 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011039 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011040 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011041 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011042 server is selected.
11043
11044 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11045 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11046 the "stick-table" statement.
11047
11048 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11049 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11050 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11051 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11052 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11053 address.
11054
11055 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11056 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11057 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11058 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11059 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11060 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11061 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11062 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11063 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11064 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11065
11066 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11067 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11068 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11069 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11070 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11071 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11072 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11073
11074 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11075 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11076 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11077 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11078
11079 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11080 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11081 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11082 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11083 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11084 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011085 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11086 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11087 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11088 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11089 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11090 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011091
11092 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11093 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11094 the request.
11095
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011096 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11097 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011098 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011099
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011100 Example :
11101 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11102 # last 30 minutes
11103 backend pop
11104 mode tcp
11105 balance roundrobin
11106 stick store-request src
11107 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11108 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11109 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11110
11111 backend smtp
11112 mode tcp
11113 balance roundrobin
11114 stick match src table pop
11115 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11116 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11117
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011118 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011119 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011120
11121
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011122stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011123 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011124 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011125 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011127 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011128
11129 Arguments :
11130 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11131 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11132 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11133 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11134
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011135 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11136 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11137 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11138 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11139
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011140 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11141 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11142 instance.
11143
11144 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11145 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11146 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11147 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11148 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11149 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011150 to 32 characters.
11151
11152 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11153 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11154 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011155 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011156 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11157 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011158
11159 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011160 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11161 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011162 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11163 increase.
11164
11165 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011166 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11167 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11168 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011169
11170 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
11171 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
11172 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11173 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011174 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011175 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11176 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11177 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11178 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11179 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11180 parameter (see below).
11181
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011182 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11183 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11184 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11185 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11186 soft restart.
11187
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011188 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11189 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011190
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011191 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11192 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11193 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11194 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011195 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011196 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011197 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11198 if not expiration delay is specified.
11199
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011200 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11201 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11202 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11203 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11204 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11205 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11206 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11207 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11208 token.
11209
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011210 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11211 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11212 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11213 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011214 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11215 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11216 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11217 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11218 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11219 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11220 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11221 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11222 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11223 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11224 types and their arguments.
11225
11226 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11227 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11228 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11229 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11230
11231 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11232 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11233 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011234 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011235
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011236 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11237 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11238 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011239 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011240 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011241 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011242
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011243 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11244 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11245 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11246 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11247
11248 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11249 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11250 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11251 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11252 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11253 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11254
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011255 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11256 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11257 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11258 they were received.
11259
11260 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11261 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11262 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11263 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11264 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11265
11266 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11267 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11268 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11269 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11270 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11271
11272 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11273 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11274 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11275
11276 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11277 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11278 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11279 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11280 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11281
11282 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11283 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11284 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11285 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11286 the client side.
11287
11288 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11289 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11290 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11291 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11292 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11293 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11294 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11295
11296 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11297 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11298 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11299 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11300 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11301 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011302 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011303
11304 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11305 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11306 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11307 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11308 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11309 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11310
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011311 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11312 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11313 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11314 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11315 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11316
11317 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11318 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11319 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11320 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11321 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11322 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11323
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011324 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011325 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011326 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11327 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11328
11329 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11330 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11331 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11332 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11333 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11334 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11335 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11336 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11337 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11338 recommended for better fairness.
11339
11340 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011341 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011342 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11343 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11344
11345 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11346 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11347 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11348 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11349 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11350 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11351 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11352 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11353 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11354 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011355
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011356 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11357 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011358 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11359 reference it.
11360
11361 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11362 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011363 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11364 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11365 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011366
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011367 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11368 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11369 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11370 something that can be ignored.
11371
11372 Example:
11373 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11374 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11375 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11376 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11377
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011378 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011379 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011380
11381
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011382stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011383 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11385 no | no | yes | yes
11386
11387 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011388 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011389 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011390 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011391 server is selected.
11392
11393 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11394 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11395 the "stick-table" statement.
11396
11397 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11398 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11399 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11400 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11401
11402 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11403 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11404 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11405 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11406 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11407 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011408 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011409 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11410 rules.
11411
11412 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11413 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11414 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11415 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11416 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11417 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11418 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11419
11420 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11421 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11422 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11423 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11424
11425 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11426 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11427 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11428 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11429 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11430 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011431 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11432 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11433 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11434 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11435 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11436 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11437 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11438 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11439 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011440
11441 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11442
11443 Example :
11444 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11445 backend https
11446 mode tcp
11447 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011448 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011449 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011450
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011451 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11452 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11453
11454 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11455 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11456 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11457
11458 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11459 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011460
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011461 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11462 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11463 # at offset 44.
11464
11465 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11466 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11467
11468 # Learn on response if server hello.
11469 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011470
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011471 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11472 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11473
11474 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11475 extraction.
11476
11477
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011478tcp-check comment <string>
11479 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11480 it fails.
11481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11482 yes | no | yes | yes
11483
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011484 Arguments :
11485 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11486 rule fails.
11487
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011488 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11489 user-friendly error reporting.
11490
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011491 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11492 "tcp-check expect".
11493
11494
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011495tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11496 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011497 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011498 Opens a new connection
11499 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011500 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011501
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011502 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011503 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11504
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011505 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011506 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011507
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011508 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011509 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11510 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011511 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011512
11513 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011514
11515 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11516
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011517 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11518
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011519 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11520
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011521 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11522
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011523 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11524 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11525 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11526 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11527
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011528 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11529 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11530 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11531 haproxy -vv.
11532
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011533 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011534
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011535 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11536 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11537 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11538
11539 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11540 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11541 of the sequence.
11542
11543 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11544 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11545 do.
11546
11547 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11548 unset-var or comment rules.
11549
11550 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011551 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11552 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11553 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11554 option tcp-check
11555 tcp-check connect
11556 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11557 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11558 tcp-check send \r\n
11559 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11560 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11561 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11562 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11563 tcp-check send \r\n
11564 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11565 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11566
11567 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11568 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011569 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011570 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11571 tcp-check connect port 143
11572 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11573 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11574
11575 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11576
11577
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011578tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011579 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011580 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011581 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011582 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011584 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011585
11586 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011587 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11588
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011589 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11590 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11591 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11592 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11593 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11594 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11595 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11596 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11597 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11598 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11599
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011600 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011601 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11602 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011603 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11604 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11605 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11606
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011607 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11608 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11609 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011610 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11611 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011612 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11613 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011614 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11615 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011616 By default "L7OK" is used.
11617
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011618 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11619 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011620 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11621 supported :
11622 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11623 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011624 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11625 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11626 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11627 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11628 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011629
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011630 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011631 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011632 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11633 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11634 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11635 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011636 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11637
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011638 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11639 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11640 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11641 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11642
11643 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11644 informational message reported in logs if an error
11645 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11646 log-format string.
11647
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011648 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11649 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11650 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11651 followed by some converters.
11652
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011653 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11654 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11655 with the usual backslash ('\').
11656 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011657 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011658 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11659 used upper or lower case.
11660
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011661 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11662
11663 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11664 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11665 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11666 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11667 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11668 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11669 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11670 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11671
11672 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11673 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11674 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11675 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11676 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11677 expression.
11678
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011679 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11680 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11681 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11682 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11683 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11684 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11685
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011686 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11687 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11688 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11689 this exact hexadecimal string.
11690 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11691
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011692 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11693 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11694 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11695 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11696 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11697 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11698 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11699 size.
11700
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011701 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11702 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11703 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11704 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11705 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11706 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11707 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11708 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11709 in a binary string before matching the response's
11710 buffer.
11711
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011712 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011713 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011714 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11715 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11716 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11717 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11718 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11719 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11720 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11721 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11722 the null character.
11723
11724 Examples :
11725 # perform a POP check
11726 option tcp-check
11727 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11728
11729 # perform an IMAP check
11730 option tcp-check
11731 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11732
11733 # look for the redis master server
11734 option tcp-check
11735 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011736 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011737 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11738 tcp-check expect string role:master
11739 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11740 tcp-check expect string +OK
11741
11742
11743 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011744 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011745
11746
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011747tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11748tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11749 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11750 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011752 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011753
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011754 Arguments :
11755 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11756
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011757 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11758 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011759
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011760 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11761 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011762
11763 Examples :
11764 # look for the redis master server
11765 option tcp-check
11766 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11767 tcp-check expect string role:master
11768
11769 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011770 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011771
11772
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011773tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11774tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11775 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11776 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011778 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011779
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011780 Arguments :
11781 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011782
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011783 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11784 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011785
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011786 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11787 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11788 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011789
11790 Examples :
11791 # redis check in binary
11792 option tcp-check
11793 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11794 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11795
11796
11797 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011798 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011799
11800
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011801tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011802 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011803 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011804 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011805
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011806 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011807 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11808 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11809 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11810 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11811 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11812 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11813 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11814 and '-'.
11815
11816 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11817
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011818 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011819 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11820
11821
11822tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011823 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011824 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011825 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011826
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011827 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011828 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11829 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11830 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11831 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11832 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11833 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11834 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11835 and '-'.
11836
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011837 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011838 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11839
11840
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011841tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11842 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11844 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011845 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011846 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11847 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011848
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011849 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011850
11851 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11852 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011853 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11854 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11855 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11856 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11857 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11858 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011859
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011860 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11861 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11862 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11863 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011864
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011865 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011866 - accept :
11867 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11868 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11869 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011870
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011871 - reject :
11872 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11873 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11874 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11875 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11876 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11877 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11878 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11879 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11880 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11881 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11882 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011883 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011884
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011885 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11886 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11887 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11888 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11889 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11890 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11891 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11892 hosts.
11893
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011894 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11895 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11896 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11897 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11898 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11899 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11900 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11901 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11902
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011903 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11904 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11905 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11906 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11907 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11908 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11909 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11910 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11911 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011912 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11913 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011914
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011915 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011916 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011917 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11918 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11919 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011920 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011921 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011922 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11923 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11924 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11925 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11926 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11927 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11928 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011929
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011930 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011931 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011932 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011933 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011934 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11935 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11936 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011937
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011938 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11939 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11940 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11941 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011942
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011943 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11944 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11945 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11946 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11947 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011948 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11949 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11950 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11951 layer7 information is extracted.
11952
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011953 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11954 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11955 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11956 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11957 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011958
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011959 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11960 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11961 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11962 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11963
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011964 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11965 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11966 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11967 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11968
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011969 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11970 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11971 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11972 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11973 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011974
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011975 - set-src <expr> :
11976 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11977 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11978 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011979 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011981 Arguments:
11982 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11983 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011984
11985 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011986 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11987
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011988 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11989 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011990
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011991 - set-src-port <expr> :
11992 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11993 expression.
11994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011995 Arguments:
11996 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11997 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011998
11999 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012000 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12001
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012002 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12003 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12004 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012005
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012006 - set-dst <expr> :
12007 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12008 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12009 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12010 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12011 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12012
12013 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12014 followed by some converters.
12015
12016 Example:
12017
12018 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12019 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12020
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012021 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12022 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12023
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012024 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12025 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12026 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12027 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12028
12029
12030 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12031 followed by some converters.
12032
12033 Example:
12034
12035 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12036
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012037 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12038 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12039 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12040
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012041 - "silent-drop" :
12042 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012043 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012044 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12045 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12046 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12047 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12048 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012049 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12050 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012051 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12052 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012053 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012054 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12055 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12056 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12057 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12058
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012059 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12060 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12061 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012063 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12064 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12065 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012066
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012067 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012068 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012069 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012070
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012071 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12072 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12073 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012074
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012075 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012076 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12077 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012078
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012079 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12080
12081 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12082
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012083 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12084
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012085 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012086
12087
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012088tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12089 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012091 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012092 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012093 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12094 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012095
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012096 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012097
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012098 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012099 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12100 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012101 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12102 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012103
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012104 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12105 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12106 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12107 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012108 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
12109 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
12110 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12111 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12112 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12113 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012114 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012115 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012116
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012117 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12118 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12119 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12120 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012121
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012122 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012123 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012124 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012125 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12126 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012127 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012128 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012129 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012130 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012131 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012132 - set-dst <expr>
12133 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012134 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012135 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012136 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012137 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012138 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012139 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012141 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12142 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012143 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12144 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012145
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012146 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12147 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12148 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12149 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12150 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12151 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012152
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012153 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012154 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12155 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012156
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012157 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12158 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12159 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12160 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12161 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12162 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12163
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012164 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012165 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12166 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12167 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12168 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12169 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12170 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12171 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12172 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12173 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12174 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012175
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012176 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012177 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12178 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12179 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012180
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012181 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12182 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12183
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012184 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012185 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12186 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012187
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012188 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12189 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012190 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012191 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12192 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012193 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012194 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012195 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012196 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12197 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012198 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012199 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12200 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012201
12202 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12203 followed by some converters.
12204
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012205 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
12206 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12207 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12208 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12209 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12210 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12211 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +050012212 warning. These directives will be conditionaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012213 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12214 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12215
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012216 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12217
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012218 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12219 <var-name>.
12220
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012221 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12222 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12223 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12224 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12225 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12226
12227 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12228 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12229 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12230 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12231 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12232 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12233 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12234 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12235 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12236 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12237 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12238
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012239 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12240 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12241 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12242 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12243 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12244
12245 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12246
12247 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12248
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012249 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12250 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12251 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12252 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12253 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12254 evaluated.
12255
12256 Example:
12257 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12258
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012259 Example:
12260
12261 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012262 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012263
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012264 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012265 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012266 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012267 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12268 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012269 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012270 tcp-request content reject
12271
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012272 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12273 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12274 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12275 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12276 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12277 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12278 ...
12279 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12280
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012281 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012282 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12283 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12284 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012285 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012286
12287 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12288 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12289 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012290 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012291 tcp-request content reject
12292
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012293 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012294 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012295 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012296 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012297 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12298 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012299
12300 Example:
12301 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12302 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012303 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012304
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012305 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012306 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012307
12308 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012309 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012310 # protecting all our sites
12311 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012312 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12313 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012314 ...
12315 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12316
12317 backend http_dynamic
12318 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012319 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012320 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012321 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012322 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012323 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012324 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012326 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012327
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012328 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12329 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012330
12331
12332tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12333 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012335 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012336 Arguments :
12337 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12338 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12339 as explained at the top of this document.
12340
12341 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12342 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12343 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12344 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12345 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12346
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012347 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12348 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12349 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12350 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12351
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012352 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12353 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012354 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012355 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012356 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12357 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12358 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12359 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012360
12361 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12362 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12363 it pass through unaffected.
12364
12365 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12366 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12367 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012368 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012369 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12370 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012371 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12372 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12373 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012374
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012375 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012376 "timeout client".
12377
12378
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012379tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12380 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12382 no | no | yes | yes
12383 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012384 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12385 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012386
12387 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12388
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012389 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012390 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12391 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012392 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12393 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012394
12395 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12396
12397 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12398 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12399 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12400 inserted.
12401
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012402 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012403 - accept :
12404 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12405 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12406 the rules evaluation.
12407
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012408 - close :
12409 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12410 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12411 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12412 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12413 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12414 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012415 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012416 protocols.
12417
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012418 - reject :
12419 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12420 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012421 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012422
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012423 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12424 Sets a variable.
12425
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012426 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12427 Unsets a variable.
12428
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012429 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12430 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12431 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12432 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12433
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012434 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12435 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12436 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12437 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12438
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012439 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12440 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12441 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12442 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12443 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012444
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012445 - "silent-drop" :
12446 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012447 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012448 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12449 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12450 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12451 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12452 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012453 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12454 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012455 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12456 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012457 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012458 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12459 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12460 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12461 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12462
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012463 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12464 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12465
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012466 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12467 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12468 for changing the default action to a reject.
12469
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012470 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12471 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12472 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12473 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012474 period.
12475
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012476 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12477 declared inline.
12478
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012479 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12480 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012481 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012482 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12483 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012484 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012485 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012486 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012487 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12488 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012489 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012490 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12491 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012492
12493 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12494 followed by some converters.
12495
12496 Example:
12497
12498 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12499
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012500 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12501 <var-name>.
12502
12503 Example:
12504
12505 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12506
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012507 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12508 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12509 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12510 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12511 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12512
12513 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12514
12515 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12516
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012517 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12518
12519 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12520
12521
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012522tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12523 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12525 no | yes | yes | no
12526 Arguments :
12527 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12528 below.
12529
12530 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12531
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012532 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012533 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12534 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12535 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12536 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12537 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12538 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12539 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012540 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012541 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12542 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12543 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12544 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12545 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12546 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12547 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12548 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12549 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12550 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12551 instead.
12552
12553 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12554 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12555 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12556 rules which may be inserted.
12557
12558 Several types of actions are supported :
12559 - accept : the request is accepted
12560 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12561 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12562 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012563 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012564 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012565 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012566 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012567 - silent-drop
12568
12569 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12570 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12571 sections for a complete description.
12572
12573 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12574 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12575 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12576
12577 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12578 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12579 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12580 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12581 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12582
12583 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12584 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12585
12586 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12587 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12588 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12589
12590 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12591 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12592 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12593
12594 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12595 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12596 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12597
12598 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12599 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12600 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12601
12602 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12603
12604 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12605
12606
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012607tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12608 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12610 no | no | yes | yes
12611 Arguments :
12612 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12613 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12614 as explained at the top of this document.
12615
12616 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12617
12618
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012619timeout check <timeout>
12620 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12621 established.
12622
12623 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12624 yes | no | yes | yes
12625 Arguments:
12626 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12627 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12628 as explained at the top of this document.
12629
12630 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12631 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012632 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012633 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012634 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12635 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12636 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012637
12638 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12639 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12640
12641 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12642 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012643 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012644
12645 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12646 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12647 forget about it.
12648
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012649 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12650 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012651
12652
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012653timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012654 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12656 yes | yes | yes | no
12657 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012658 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012659 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12660 as explained at the top of this document.
12661
12662 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12663 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12664 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012665 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12666 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12667 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12668 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012669 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12670 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12671 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012672 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012673 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012674 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12675 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012676 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12677 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012678
12679 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12680 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12681 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12682 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012683 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012684 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12685
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012686 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012687
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012688 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012690
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012691timeout client-fin <timeout>
12692 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12694 yes | yes | yes | no
12695 Arguments :
12696 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12697 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12698 as explained at the top of this document.
12699
12700 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12701 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12702 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12703 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12704 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12705 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12706 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012707 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12708 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12709 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012710
12711 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12712 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12713 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12714
12715 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12716
12717
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012718timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012719 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12721 yes | no | yes | yes
12722 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012723 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012724 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12725 as explained at the top of this document.
12726
12727 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012728 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012729 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012730 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012731 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12732 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012733
12734 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12735 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12736 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12737 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012738 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012739 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12740
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012741 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012742
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012743
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012744timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12745 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12747 yes | yes | yes | yes
12748 Arguments :
12749 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12750 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12751 as explained at the top of this document.
12752
12753 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12754 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12755 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12756 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12757 once the request has started to present itself.
12758
12759 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12760 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12761 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12762 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12763 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12764
12765 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12766 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12767 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12768 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12769
12770 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12771 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012772 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012773 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12774 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012775 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012776
12777 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12778 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12779 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12780 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12781
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012782 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12783 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012784 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12785
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012786 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12787
12788
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012789timeout http-request <timeout>
12790 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012792 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012793 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012794 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012795 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12796 as explained at the top of this document.
12797
12798 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12799 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12800 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12801 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12802 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12803 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12804 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012805 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12806 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12807 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12808 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012809 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012810 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12811 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012812
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012813 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12814 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12815 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12816 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12817 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012818 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012819
12820 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12821 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012822 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012823 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12824 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12825
12826 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012827 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12828 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12829 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012830
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012831 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012832 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012833
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012834
12835timeout queue <timeout>
12836 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12838 yes | no | yes | yes
12839 Arguments :
12840 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12841 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12842 as explained at the top of this document.
12843
12844 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12845 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12846 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12847 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12848 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12849
12850 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12851 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12852 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12853 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12854
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012855 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012856
12857
12858timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012859 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12861 yes | no | yes | yes
12862 Arguments :
12863 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12864 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12865 as explained at the top of this document.
12866
12867 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12868 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12869 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12870 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12871 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12872 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12873 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12874
12875 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12876 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12877 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12878 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12879 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012880 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012881 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012882 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12883 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012884 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12885 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012886
12887 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12888 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12889 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12890 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012891 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012892 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12893
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012894 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012895
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012896
12897timeout server-fin <timeout>
12898 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12900 yes | no | yes | yes
12901 Arguments :
12902 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12903 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12904 as explained at the top of this document.
12905
12906 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12907 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12908 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12909 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12910 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12911 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12912 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12913 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12914 situations, it should not be needed.
12915
12916 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12917 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12918 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12919
12920 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12921
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012922
12923timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012924 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12926 yes | yes | yes | yes
12927 Arguments :
12928 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12929 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12930 as explained at the top of this document.
12931
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012932 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12933 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12934 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012935
12936 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12937 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12938 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12939 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012940 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012941
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012942 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012943
12944
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012945timeout tunnel <timeout>
12946 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12948 yes | no | yes | yes
12949 Arguments :
12950 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12951 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12952 as explained at the top of this document.
12953
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012954 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012955 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12956 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12957 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012958 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12959 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012960 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12961 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12962 specified.
12963
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012964 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12965 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12966 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12967 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12968 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12969 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12970 state.
12971
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012972 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12973 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12974 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12975 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012976 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012977
12978 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12979 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12980 forget about it.
12981
12982 Example :
12983 defaults http
12984 option http-server-close
12985 timeout connect 5s
12986 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012987 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012988 timeout server 30s
12989 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12990
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012991 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012992
12993
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012994transparent (deprecated)
12995 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012997 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012998 Arguments : none
12999
13000 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13001 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13002 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13003 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13004 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13005 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13006 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13007 appropriate server.
13008
13009 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13010
13011 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13012 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13013
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013014 See also: "option transparent"
13015
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013016unique-id-format <string>
13017 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13019 yes | yes | yes | no
13020 Arguments :
13021 <string> is a log-format string.
13022
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013023 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13024 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13025 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13026 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013027
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013028 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
13029 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
13030 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13031 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13032 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13033 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13034 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13035 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013036
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013037 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13038 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013039
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013040 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013041
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013042 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013043
13044 will generate:
13045
13046 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13047
13048 See also: "unique-id-header"
13049
13050unique-id-header <name>
13051 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13053 yes | yes | yes | no
13054 Arguments :
13055 <name> is the name of the header.
13056
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013057 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13058 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013059
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013060 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013061
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013062 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013063 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13064
13065 will generate:
13066
13067 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13068
13069 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013070
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013071use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013072 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13074 no | yes | yes | no
13075 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013076 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13077 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013078
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013079 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13080 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013081
13082 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13083 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13084 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013085 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013086 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013087 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13088 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013089
13090 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13091 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13092 assign the backend.
13093
13094 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13095 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13096 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13097 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13098 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13099 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13100
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013101 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013102 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013103 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13104 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13105 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13106
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013107 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13108 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13109 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13110 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13111 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13112 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13113 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13114 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13115 cannot be forced from the request.
13116
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013117 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013118 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13119 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13120
13121 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13122 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013124use-fcgi-app <name>
13125 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13127 no | no | yes | yes
13128 Arguments :
13129 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13130
13131 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013132
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013133use-server <server> if <condition>
13134use-server <server> unless <condition>
13135 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13137 no | no | yes | yes
13138 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013139 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13140 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013141
13142 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13143
13144 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13145 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13146 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13147
13148 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13149 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13150 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13151 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13152 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13153 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13154 matches will assign the server.
13155
13156 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13157 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13158 with the next rules until one matches.
13159
13160 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13161 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13162 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13163 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13164
13165 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13166 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13167 stripped.
13168
13169 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13170 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013171 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
13172 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
13173 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013174
13175 Example :
13176 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
13177 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
13178 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
13179 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013180 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013181 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013182 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013183 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13184 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13185
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013186 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13187 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13188 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13189 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013190 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013191 and we fall back to load balancing.
13192
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013193 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013194
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013195
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100131965. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013197--------------------------
13198
13199The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13200depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13201settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13202written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13203described in this section.
13204
13205
132065.1. Bind options
13207-----------------
13208
13209The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13210as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13211no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13212parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13213while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13214provided immediately after the setting name.
13215
13216The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13217
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013218accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13219 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13220 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13221 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13222 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13223 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13224 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13225 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13226 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13227 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013228 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13229 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13230 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013231
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013232accept-proxy
13233 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013234 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13235 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013236 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13237 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13238 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13239 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013240 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013241 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13242 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013243 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13244 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013245
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013246allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013247 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013248 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013249 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013250 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13251 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013252
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013253alpn <protocols>
13254 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13255 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13256 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013257 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013258 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013259 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13260 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13261 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13262 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13263 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13264 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13265 preference, like below :
13266
13267 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013268
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013269backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013270 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013271 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13272
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013273curves <curves>
13274 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13275 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13276 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13277 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13278 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13279 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13280
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013281ecdhe <named curve>
13282 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013283 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13284 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013285
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013286ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013287 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13288 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13289 client's certificate.
13290
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013291ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13293 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13294 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13295 error is ignored.
13296
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013297ca-sign-file <cafile>
13298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13299 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13300 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13301 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13302 'generate-certificates' for details.
13303
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013304ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13306 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13307 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13308 'generate-certificates' for details.
13309
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013310ca-verify-file <cafile>
13311 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13312 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13313 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13314 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13315 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13316
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013317ciphers <ciphers>
13318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13319 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013320 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013321 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013322 information and recommendations see e.g.
13323 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13324 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13325 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13326
13327ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13328 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13329 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13330 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13331 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013332 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13333 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013334
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013335crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013336 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13337 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13338 to verify client's certificate.
13339
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013340crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013341 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13342 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13343 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13344 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13345 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013346 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13347 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013348
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013349 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13350 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13351
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013352 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13353 are loaded.
13354
13355 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013356 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13357 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13358 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13359 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13360 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13361 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13362 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013363 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013364
13365 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13366 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13367 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13368 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013369 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13370 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013371
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013372 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013374 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013375 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013376 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13377 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013378 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13379 clients).
13380
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013381 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13382 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13383 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13384 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13385 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13386 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13387 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13388 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13389 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13390 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13391 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13392 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13393 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13394
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013395 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13396 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13397 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13398 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13399 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13400
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013401 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13402 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13403 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13404 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013405
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013406 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13407 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13408 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013409
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013410crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013411 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013412 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013413 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013414 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013415
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013416crt-list <file>
13417 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013418 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13419 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013420
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013421 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13422
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013423 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13424 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13425 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13426 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13427 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013428
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013429 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013430 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13431 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13432 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13433 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13434 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013435 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13436 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13437 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013438
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013439 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13440 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13441 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013442
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013443 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13444
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013445 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13446 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13447 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13448 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13449 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13450 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13451 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13452 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013453
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013454 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013455 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013456 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013457 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013458 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013459 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013460
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013461defer-accept
13462 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13463 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13464 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013465 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013466 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13467 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13468 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13469 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13470 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13471 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13472 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13473
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013474expose-fd listeners
13475 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13476 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013477 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13478 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013479 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013480
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013481force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013482 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013483 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013484 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013485 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013486
13487force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013488 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013489 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013490 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013491
13492force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013493 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013494 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013495 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013496
13497force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013498 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013499 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013500 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013501
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013502force-tlsv13
13503 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13504 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013505 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013506
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013507generate-certificates
13508 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13509 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13510 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13511 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13512 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13513 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13514 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13515 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13516 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13517 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13518 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13519
13520 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13521 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013522 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013523 certificate is used many times.
13524
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013525gid <gid>
13526 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13527 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13528 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13529 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13530 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13531
13532group <group>
13533 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13534 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13535 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13536 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13537 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13538
13539id <id>
13540 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13541 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13542 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13543 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13544
13545interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013546 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13547 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13548 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13549 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13550 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13551 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013552 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13553 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13554 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13555 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13556 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13557 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013558
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013559level <level>
13560 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13561 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13562 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013563 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013564 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13565 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13566 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013567 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013568 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013569 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013570 all counters).
13571
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013572severity-output <format>
13573 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13574 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13575 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13576 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13577 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13578 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13579 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13580 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13581 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13582 rfc5424 convention.
13583
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013584maxconn <maxconn>
13585 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13586 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13587 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13588 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13589 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13590 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13591 eat all memory.
13592
13593mode <mode>
13594 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13595 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13596 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13597 UNIX sockets.
13598
13599mss <maxseg>
13600 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13601 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13602 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13603 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13604 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13605 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13606 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13607 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13608 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13609 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13610 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13611
13612name <name>
13613 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13614 page.
13615
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013616namespace <name>
13617 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13618 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13619 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13620 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13621
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013622nice <nice>
13623 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13624 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13625 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13626 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13627 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13628 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13629 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13630 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13631 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13632 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13633 one for an RDP socket.
13634
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013635no-ca-names
13636 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13637 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013638 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013639
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013640no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013641 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013642 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013643 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013644 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013645 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13646 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013647
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013648no-tls-tickets
13649 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13650 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13651 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013652 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13653 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013654 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13655 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13656 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013657
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013658no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013659 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013660 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013661 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013662 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013663 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13664 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013665
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013666no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013668 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013669 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013670 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013671 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13672 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013673
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013674no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013675 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013676 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013677 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013678 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013679 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13680 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013681
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013682no-tlsv13
13683 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13684 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13685 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13686 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013687 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13688 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013689
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013690npn <protocols>
13691 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13692 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13693 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013694 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013695 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013696 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13697 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13698 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13699 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13700 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013701
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013702prefer-client-ciphers
13703 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13704 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13705 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013706 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13707 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13708 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013709
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013710process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013711 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013712 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013713 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013714 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13715 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13716 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13717 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013718 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013719 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13720 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13721 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13722 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13723 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013724
13725 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13726
13727 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13728 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13729 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13730 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13731 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13732 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13733 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13734 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013735
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013736proto <name>
13737 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13738 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13739 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013740 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13741 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13742
13743 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13744 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13745 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13746 also reported (flag=HTX).
13747
13748 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13749 a bind line :
13750
13751 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13752 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13753 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13754
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013755 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013756 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013757 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013758 h2" on the bind line.
13759
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013760ssl
13761 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013762 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013763 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13764 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013765 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13766 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013767
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013768ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13769 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013770 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13771 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13772 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013773 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13774
13775ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013776 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13777 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13778 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13779 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013780
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013781strict-sni
13782 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13783 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13784 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13785 See the "crt" option for more information.
13786
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013787tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013788 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013789 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13790 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013791 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013792 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13793 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13794 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13795 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13796 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13797 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13798 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13799
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013800tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013801 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013802 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13803 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13804 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13805 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13806 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13807 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13808 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013809 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13810 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13811 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013812
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013813tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13814 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013815 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13816 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13817 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13818 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13819 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13820 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13821 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13822 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13823 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13824 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013825 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13826 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13827
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013828transparent
13829 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13830 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13831 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13832 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13833 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13834 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13835 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13836 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13837 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13838 so check for support with your vendor.
13839
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013840v4v6
13841 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13842 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13843 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13844 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013845 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013846
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013847v6only
13848 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13849 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13850 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013851 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13852 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013853
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013854uid <uid>
13855 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13856 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13857 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13858 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13859 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13860
13861user <user>
13862 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13863 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13864 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13865 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13866 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13867
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013868verify [none|optional|required]
13869 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13870 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13871 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13872 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13873 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013874 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13875 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13876 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13877 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013878
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200138795.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013880------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013881
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013882The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13883which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13884arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13885settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13886after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13887Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13888address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013890 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013891 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013892
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013893Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13894keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013896The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013897
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013898addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013899 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013900 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13901 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13902 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13903 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13904 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013905
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013906agent-check
13907 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013908 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013909 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13910 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13911 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013912
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013913 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013914 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013915 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13916 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13917 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013918
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013919 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13920 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13921 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13922 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13923 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013924
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013925 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013926 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013927
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013928 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13929 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13930 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013931
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013932 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13933 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13934 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013935
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013936 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013937 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13938 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13939 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13940 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013941 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013942 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013943
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013944 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13945 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013946
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013947 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13948 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13949 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13950 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13951 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13952 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13953 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13954 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13955 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013956
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013957 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13958 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013959 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13960 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13961 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013962 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013963
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013964 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013965 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013966
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013967agent-send <string>
13968 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13969 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13970 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13971 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13972 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13973
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013974agent-inter <delay>
13975 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13976 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13977
13978 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13979 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13980 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13981 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13982 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13983 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13984 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13985 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13986 of backends use the same servers.
13987
13988 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13989
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013990agent-addr <addr>
13991 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13992
13993 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13994 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13995 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13996 hostname, it will be resolved.
13997
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013998agent-port <port>
13999 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14000
14001 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14002
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014003allow-0rtt
14004 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014005 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14006 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014007
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014008alpn <protocols>
14009 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14010 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14011 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014012 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014013 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14014 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14015 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14016 now obsolete NPN extension.
14017 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14018 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14019
14020 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014022backup
14023 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14024 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14025 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14026 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014027 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14028 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014029
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014030ca-file <cafile>
14031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14032 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14033 server's certificate.
14034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014035check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014036 This option enables health checks on a server:
14037 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14038 considered available.
14039 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14040 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14041 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14042 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14043 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14044 set.
14045 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14046 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14047 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14048 exchanges succeed.
14049
14050 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14051 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14052 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14053 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14054 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014055 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014056 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14057
14058 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14059 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14060
14061 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14062 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14063
14064 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14065 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14066 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14067 available.
14068
14069 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14070 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14071 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14072
14073 Example:
14074 # simple tcp check
14075 backend foo
14076 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14077 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14078 backend foo
14079 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14080 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14081 backend foo
14082 option tcp-check
14083 tcp-check connect
14084 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014085
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014086check-send-proxy
14087 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14088 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14089 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14090 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14091 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14092 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14093 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14094
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014095check-alpn <protocols>
14096 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14097 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14098 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14099
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014100check-proto <name>
14101 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14102 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14103 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014104 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14105 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14106
14107 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14108 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14109 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14110 also reported (flag=HTX).
14111
14112 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14113 directive on a server line:
14114
14115 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14116 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14117 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14118 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14119
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014120 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014121 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14122 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14123
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014124check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014125 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014126 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14127 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014128
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014129check-ssl
14130 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14131 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14132 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14133 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014134 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014135 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14136 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014137 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014138 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14139 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014140
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014141check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014142 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014143 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14144 for normal traffic.
14145
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014146ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14148 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14149 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014150 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14151 information and recommendations see e.g.
14152 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14153 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14154 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014155
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014156ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14157 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14158 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14159 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14160 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014161 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14162 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14163 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014165cookie <value>
14166 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14167 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14168 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14169 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14170 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14171 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14172 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14173
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014174crl-file <crlfile>
14175 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14176 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14177 to verify server's certificate.
14178
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014179crt <cert>
14180 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14181 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14182 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14183 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14184 certificate request.
14185
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014186disabled
14187 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14188 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14189 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14190 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14191 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014192 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014193
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014194enabled
14195 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14196 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14197 default value.
14198 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14199 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014201error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014202 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14203 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14204 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014205
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014206 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014208fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014209 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14210 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14211 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14212
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014213force-sslv3
14214 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14215 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014216 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014217 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014218
14219force-tlsv10
14220 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014221 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014222 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014223
14224force-tlsv11
14225 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014226 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014227 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014228
14229force-tlsv12
14230 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014231 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014232 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014233
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014234force-tlsv13
14235 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14236 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014237 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014239id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014240 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14241 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14242 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014243
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014244init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14245 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14246 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014247 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014248 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14249 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14250 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14251 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14252 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14253 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14254 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14255 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14256 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014257 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014258 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14259 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14260 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14261 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14262 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14263 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014264 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014265
14266 Example:
14267 defaults
14268 # never fail on address resolution
14269 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014271inter <delay>
14272fastinter <delay>
14273downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014274 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14275 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14276 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14277 between checks depending on the server state :
14278
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014279 Server state | Interval used
14280 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14281 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14282 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14283 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14284 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14285 or yet unchecked. |
14286 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14287 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14288 | "inter" otherwise.
14289 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014291 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14292 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14293 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14294 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014295 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14296 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14297 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14298 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14299 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014300
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014301log-proto <logproto>
14302 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14303 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14304 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14305 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014307maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014308 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14309 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014310 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14311 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014312 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14313 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14314 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14315 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14316
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014317 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14318 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14319 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14320 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14321 than 50 concurrent requests.
14322
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014323maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014324 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14325 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14326 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14327 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014328 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14329 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14330 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14331 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14332 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14333 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14334 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014335
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014336max-reuse <count>
14337 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14338 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14339 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14340 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14341 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14342 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14343 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14344 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014346minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014347 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14348 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14349 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14350 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14351 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14352 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014353 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014354 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014355
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014356namespace <name>
14357 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14358 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14359 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14360 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14361
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014362no-agent-check
14363 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14364 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14365 default value.
14366 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14367 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14368
14369no-backup
14370 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14371 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14372 default value.
14373 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14374 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14375
14376no-check
14377 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14378 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14379 default value.
14380 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14381 "default-server" "check" setting.
14382
14383no-check-ssl
14384 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14385 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14386 default value.
14387 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14388 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14389
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014390no-send-proxy
14391 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14392 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14393 default value.
14394 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14395 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14396
14397no-send-proxy-v2
14398 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14399 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14400 default value.
14401 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14402 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14403
14404no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14405 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14406 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14407 default value.
14408 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14409 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14410
14411no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14412 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14413 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14414 default value.
14415 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14416 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14417
14418no-ssl
14419 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14420 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14421 default value.
14422 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14423 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14424
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014425 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14426 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14427 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14428
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014429no-ssl-reuse
14430 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14431 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14432 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14433 and for paranoid users.
14434
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014435no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014436 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14437 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014438 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014439
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014440 Supported in default-server: No
14441
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014442no-tls-tickets
14443 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14444 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14445 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014446 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14447 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014448 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14449 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14450 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014451 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014452
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014453no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014454 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014455 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14456 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014457 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14458 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014459 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014460
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014461 Supported in default-server: No
14462
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014463no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014464 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014465 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14466 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014467 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14468 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014469 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014470
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014471 Supported in default-server: No
14472
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014473no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014474 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014475 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14476 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014477 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14478 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014479 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014480
14481 Supported in default-server: No
14482
14483no-tlsv13
14484 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14485 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14486 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14487 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14488 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014489 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014490
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014491 Supported in default-server: No
14492
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014493no-verifyhost
14494 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14495 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14496 default value.
14497 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14498 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014499
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014500no-tfo
14501 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14502 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14503 default value.
14504 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14505 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14506
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014507non-stick
14508 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14509 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14510 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14511
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014512npn <protocols>
14513 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14514 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14515 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014516 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014517 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14518 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14519 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014521observe <mode>
14522 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14523 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14524 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14525 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14526 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14527 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014528 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014529
14530 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14531
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014532on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014533 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14534 Currently, four modes are available:
14535 - fastinter: force fastinter
14536 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14537 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14538 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14539 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14540
14541 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14542
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014543on-marked-down <action>
14544 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14545 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014546 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14547 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14548 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14549 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14550 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14551 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14552 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14553 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014554
14555 Actions are disabled by default
14556
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014557on-marked-up <action>
14558 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14559 Currently one action is available:
14560 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14561 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14562 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14563 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014564 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14565 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014566 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14567 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14568
14569 Actions are disabled by default
14570
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014571pool-low-conn <max>
14572 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14573 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14574 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14575 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14576 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14577 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14578 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14579 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14580 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14581 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014582 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14583 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14584 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14585 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014586
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014587pool-max-conn <max>
14588 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14589 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14590 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14591 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14592 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14593 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14594
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014595pool-purge-delay <delay>
14596 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014597 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014598 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014599
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014600port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014601 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014602 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14603 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14604 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14605 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14606 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014607
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014608proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014609 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14610 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14611 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014612 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14613 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14614
14615 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14616 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14617 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14618 also reported (flag=HTX).
14619
14620 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14621 a server line :
14622
14623 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14624 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14625 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14626 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14627
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014628 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014629 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014631redir <prefix>
14632 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14633 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14634 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14635 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14636 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14637 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14638 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14639 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014640 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014641 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014642 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14643 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14644 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14645 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14646
14647 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014649rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014650 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14651 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14652 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14653
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014654resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14655 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14656 server.
14657
14658 Available options:
14659
14660 * allow-dup-ip
14661 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14662 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14663 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14664 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14665 For such case, simply enable this option.
14666 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14667
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014668 * ignore-weight
14669 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14670 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14671 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14672
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014673 * prevent-dup-ip
14674 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14675 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14676 same fqdn.
14677 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14678
14679 Example:
14680 backend b_myapp
14681 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14682 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14683 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14684
14685 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14686 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14687 it
14688 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14689 different address
14690
14691 Default value: not set
14692
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014693resolve-prefer <family>
14694 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14695 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14696 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14697 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14698
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014699 Default value: ipv6
14700
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014701 Example:
14702
14703 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014704
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014705resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014706 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014707 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014708 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014709 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14710 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014711 configured network, another address is selected.
14712
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014713 Example:
14714
14715 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014716
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014717resolvers <id>
14718 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14719 hostname.
14720
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014721 Example:
14722
14723 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014724
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014725 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014726
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014727send-proxy
14728 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14729 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14730 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14731 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014732 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14733 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14734 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14735 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14736 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14737 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14738 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14739 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14740 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14741 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014742 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14743 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014744
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014745send-proxy-v2
14746 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14747 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14748 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14749 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014750 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14751 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14752 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14753 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014754
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014755proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014756 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14757 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14758
14759 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14760 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14761 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14762 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14763 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14764 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14765 connection is supported).
14766 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14767 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14768 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14769 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14770 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14771 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14772 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014773
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014774send-proxy-v2-ssl
14775 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14776 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14777 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14778 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14779 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14780 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14781 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014782 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14783 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014784
14785send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14786 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14787 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14788 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14789 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14790 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14791 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14792 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14793 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014794 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14795 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014796
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014797slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014798 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14799 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14800 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14801 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14802 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14803 parameters :
14804
14805 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14806 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14807
14808 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14809 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14810 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14811 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14812
14813 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14814 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14815 seen as failed.
14816
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014817sni <expression>
14818 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14819 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14820 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14821 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014822 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14823 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014824 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014825 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14826 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014827
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014828source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014829source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014830source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014831 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14832 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14833 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14834 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14835
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014836 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14837 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14838 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14839 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14840 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14841 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14842 server.
14843
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014844 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14845 specifying the source address without port(s).
14846
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014847ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014848 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14849 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14850 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14851 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14852 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14853 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014854 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14855 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014856
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014857ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14858 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14859 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14860 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14861
14862ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14863 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14864 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14865 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14866
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014867ssl-reuse
14868 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14869 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14870 default value.
14871 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14872 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14873
14874stick
14875 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14876 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14877 default value.
14878 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14879 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014880
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014881socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014882 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014883 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14884 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14885
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014886tcp-ut <delay>
14887 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14888 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14889 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014890 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014891 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14892 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14893 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14894 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14895 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14896 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14897 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14898 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14899 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14900
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014901tfo
14902 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14903 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14904 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14905 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14906 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014907 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014909track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014910 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14911 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14912 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14913 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014914 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14915
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014916tls-tickets
14917 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14918 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14919 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014920 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14921 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14922 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014923 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014924 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014925
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014926verify [none|required]
14927 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014928 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014929 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14930 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014931 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014932 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14933 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14934 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14935 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14936 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14937 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14938 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14939 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014940
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014941verifyhost <hostname>
14942 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014943 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14944 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14945 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14946 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14947 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14948 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14949 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14950 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014951
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014952weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014953 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14954 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14955 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014956 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14957 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14958 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14959 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14960 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14961 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014962
14963
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149645.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14965-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014966
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014967HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14968using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014969configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014970This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14971can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14972workload.
14973This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14974resolution at run time.
14975Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14976carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14977
14978
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149795.3.1. Global overview
14980----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014981
14982As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14983different steps of the process life:
14984
14985 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14986 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14987 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14988
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014989 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14990 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014991
14992A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14993 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14994 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14995 resolution to know this new IP.
14996
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014997When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014998HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014999SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15000from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
15001will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
15002will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015003
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015004A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015005 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015006 first valid response.
15007
15008 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15009 servers return an error.
15010
15011
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150125.3.2. The resolvers section
15013----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015014
15015This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015016HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15017contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015018
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015019When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15020uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15021is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15022answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15023
15024When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015025used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015026
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015027 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15028 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15029 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015030
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015031 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15032 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015033
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015034 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15035 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15036 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015037
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015038For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15039following scenarios are possible:
15040
15041 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15042 ignored
15043
15044 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15045 applied
15046
15047 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15048 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15049
15050 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15051 retries the query with a new type
15052
15053 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15054 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015055
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015056As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
15057a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015058<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015059
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015060
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015061resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015062 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015063
15064A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15065
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015066accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015067 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015068 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015069 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15070 by RFC 6891)
15071
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015072 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15073 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15074 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15075 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15076 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15077 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015078
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015079nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15080 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15081 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15082 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15083 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15084 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15085 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15086 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15087 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15088 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015089 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15090
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015091parse-resolv-conf
15092 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15093 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15094 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15095
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015096hold <status> <period>
15097 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15098 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015099 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015100 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015101 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15102 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15103 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15104
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015105 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015106
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015107resolve_retries <nb>
15108 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15109 giving up.
15110 Default value: 3
15111
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015112 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15113 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15114 type.
15115
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015116timeout <event> <time>
15117 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15118 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15119 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015120 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15121 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015122 Default value: 1s
15123 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015124 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015125 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015126 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15127 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15128
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015129 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015130
15131 resolvers mydns
15132 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15133 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015134 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015135 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015136 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015137 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015138 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015139 hold other 30s
15140 hold refused 30s
15141 hold nx 30s
15142 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015143 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015144 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015145
15146
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200151476. Cache
15148---------
15149
15150HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15151(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15152RAM.
15153
15154The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15155this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15156
15157If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15158independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15159when we try to allocate a new one.
15160
15161The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15162
15163It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15164"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15165for more details.
15166
15167When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15168replaced by "<CACHE>".
15169
15170
151716.1. Limitation
15172----------------
15173
15174The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15175
15176- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015177- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15178 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15179 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015180- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15181- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015182- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15183 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15184 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015185- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15186 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015187- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15188 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15189 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015190
15191- If the request is not a GET
15192- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15193- If the request contains an Authorization header
15194
15195
151966.2. Setup
15197-----------
15198
15199To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15200the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15201
15202
152036.2.1. Cache section
15204---------------------
15205
15206cache <name>
15207 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15208 size of cache is mandatory.
15209
15210total-max-size <megabytes>
15211 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15212 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15213
15214max-object-size <bytes>
15215 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15216 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15217 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15218
15219max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015220 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015221 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15222 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15223 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15224 default.
15225
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015226process-vary <on/off>
15227 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015228 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15229 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15230 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015231 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015232
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015233max-secondary-entries <number>
15234 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15235 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15236 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15237
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015238
152396.2.2. Proxy section
15240---------------------
15241
15242http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15243 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15244 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15245 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15246 after this one.
15247
15248http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15249 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15250 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15251 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15252 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15253
15254
15255Example:
15256
15257 backend bck1
15258 mode http
15259
15260 http-request cache-use foobar
15261 http-response cache-store foobar
15262 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15263
15264 cache foobar
15265 total-max-size 4
15266 max-age 240
15267
15268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15270----------------------------------
15271
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015272HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015273client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15274The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15275these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15276but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15277data called patterns.
15278
15279
152807.1. ACL basics
15281---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015282
15283The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15284content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15285from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15286simple :
15287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015288 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015289 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015290 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15291 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015293The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15294adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015295
15296In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015298 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015299
15300This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15301Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15302and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015303an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15304conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15305as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15306are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015307
15308ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15309'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15310which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15311
15312There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15313performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015315The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15316specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15317this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015318methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15319ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320
15321Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15322 - boolean
15323 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15324 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15325 - string
15326 - data block
15327
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015328Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15329converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15330would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15331The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15332which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15333
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015334Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15335keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15336fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15337which are summarized in the table below :
15338
15339 +---------------------+-----------------+
15340 | Sample or converter | Default |
15341 | output type | matching method |
15342 +---------------------+-----------------+
15343 | boolean | bool |
15344 +---------------------+-----------------+
15345 | integer | int |
15346 +---------------------+-----------------+
15347 | ip | ip |
15348 +---------------------+-----------------+
15349 | string | str |
15350 +---------------------+-----------------+
15351 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15352 +---------------------+-----------------+
15353
15354Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15355matching method, see below.
15356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015357The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15358 - boolean
15359 - integer or integer range
15360 - IP address / network
15361 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15362 - regular expression
15363 - hex block
15364
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015365The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15366
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015367 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15368 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015369 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015370 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015371 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015372 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015373 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015375The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15376read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15377if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15378lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15379will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15380beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15381a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15382lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15383exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15384
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015385The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15386parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15387ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15388a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15389check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15390
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015391The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15392socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15393file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015395Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15396loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15397
15398 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15399
15400In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15401the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15402case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15403as well.
15404
15405The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15406sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15407do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15408methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15409is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015410obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015411followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15412default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15413that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15414string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15415
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015416The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15417By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15418string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15419resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15420server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015421waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015422flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15423function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15426sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15427be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015428
15429 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15430 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15432 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15433 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15434 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015435
15436 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15437 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015438 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015439
15440 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015442
15443 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015444 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015445
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015446 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015447 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15448
15449 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15450 binary or string samples.
15451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015452 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15453 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15456 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15457 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015459 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15460 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015462 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15463 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015465 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15466 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015468 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15469 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015470 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15473 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15474 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015475
15476For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15477request, it is possible to do :
15478
15479 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15480
15481In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15482buffer, one would use the following acl :
15483
15484 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15485
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015486On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15487possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15488
15489 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15492criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15493method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15494to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15495criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15496the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015499the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15500For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015502 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15503 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15504 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15505 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015506
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015507
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015508The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15509types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15510combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15511brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15512default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514 +-------------------------------------------------+
15515 | Input sample type |
15516 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015517 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15519 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15520 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015521 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015522 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015523 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015524 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015525 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015526 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015527 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015528 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015529 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015531 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015533 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015534 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015535 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015536 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015537 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015539 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015541 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015542 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15543 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15544 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015545
15546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155477.1.1. Matching booleans
15548------------------------
15549
15550In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15551Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15552When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15553that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15554
15555Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15556return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15557"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15558
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155607.1.2. Matching integers
15561------------------------
15562
15563Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15564enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15565to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15566
15567Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15568matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15569lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015570
15571For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15572unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15573representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15574
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015575As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15576two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15577instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15578ranges and operators.
15579
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015580For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015581operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15582Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15583of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015584
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015585Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015586
15587 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15588 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15589 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15590 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15591 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15592
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015593For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015594
15595 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15596
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015597This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15598
15599 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156027.1.3. Matching strings
15603-----------------------
15604
15605String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15606different forms :
15607
15608 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015609 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610
15611 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015612 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613
15614 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15615 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15616
15617 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15618 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15619
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015620 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15622 matches.
15623
15624 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15625 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15626 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015627
15628String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15629exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15630characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15631string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15632to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015633before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015634
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015635Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15636(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15637Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15638
15639Example:
15640 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15641 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156447.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15645---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015646
15647Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15648they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15649possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15650passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15651the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015652the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15653match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015654
15655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156567.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15657-------------------------------------
15658
15659It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15660not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15661a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15662to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15663digits may be used upper or lower case.
15664
15665Example :
15666 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15667 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15668
15669
156707.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15671---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015672
15673IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15674netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15675within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015676host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015677difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15678at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15679does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15680parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015681
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015682The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15683abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15684
15685 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15686 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15687 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15688 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15689 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15690 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15691 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15692 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15693
15694Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15695192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15696
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015697IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15698Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15699trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15700IPv6 patterns.
15701
15702HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15703following situations :
15704 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15705 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15706 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15707 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15708 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15709 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15710 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15711 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15712 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15713 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715
157167.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15717----------------------------------
15718
15719Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15720combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15721
15722 - AND (implicit)
15723 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15724 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015728 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15731indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015733For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15734"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15735requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15736is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15737
15738 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015739 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15740 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15741 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015742
15743To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15744and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15745
15746 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15747 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15748 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15749 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015751 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015752 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15753 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15754 use_backend www if host_www
15755
15756It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15757expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15758be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15759the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15760
15761 The following rule :
15762
15763 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015764 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765
15766 Can also be written that way :
15767
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015768 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015769
15770It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15771to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15772simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15773sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15774good use is the following :
15775
15776 With named ACLs :
15777
15778 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15779 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15780 monitor fail if site_dead
15781
15782 With anonymous ACLs :
15783
15784 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15785
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015786See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15787keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015788
15789
157907.3. Fetching samples
15791---------------------
15792
15793Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15794against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15795sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15796ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15797of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15798available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15799
15800This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15801Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15802compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15803deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15804
15805The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15806matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15807method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15808indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15809
15810As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15811when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15812mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15813the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15814ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15815
15816Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15817multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15818when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015819incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15820are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015821is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15822all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15823
15824Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15825 - name
15826 - name(arg1)
15827 - name(arg1,arg2)
15828
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015829
158307.3.1. Converters
15831-----------------
15832
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015833Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15834of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15835is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15836was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015837has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015838unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15839
15840These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15841sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15842the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015843support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015844
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015845A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15846support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15847supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15848(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15849bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015851The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015852
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001585351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15854 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15855 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15856 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15857 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15858 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15859
15860 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015861 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15862 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015863 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15864 frontend http-in
15865 bind *:8081
15866 default_backend servers
15867 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15868 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15869
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015870add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015871 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015872 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015873 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15874 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015875 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015876 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15877 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15878 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15879 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015880 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015881 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015882
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015883aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15884 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15885 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15886 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15887 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15888 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15889 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15890
15891 Example:
15892 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15893 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15894
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015895and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015896 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015897 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015898 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15899 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015900 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015901 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15902 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15903 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15904 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015905 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015906 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015907
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015908b64dec
15909 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15910 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015911 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15912 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015913
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015914base64
15915 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015916 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015917 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15918 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015919
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015920bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015921 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015922 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015923 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015924 presence of a flag).
15925
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015926bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15927 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15928 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015929 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015930
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015931concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15932 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15933 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15934 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15935 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15936 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15937 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15938 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15939 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15940 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15941 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015942 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015943 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015944 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15945 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015946
15947 Example:
15948 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15949 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15950 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015951 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015952 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15953
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015954cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015955 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15956 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015957
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015958crc32([<avalanche>])
15959 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15960 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15961 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15962 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15963 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15964 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15965 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15966 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15967 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15968 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015969 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15970
15971crc32c([<avalanche>])
15972 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15973 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15974 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15975 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15976 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15977 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15978 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15979 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015980
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015981cut_crlf
15982 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15983 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15984 updated.
15985
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015986da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015987 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15988 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15989 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15990 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015991 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015992 configuration language.
15993
15994 Example:
15995 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015996 bind *:8881
15997 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015998 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015999
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016000debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16001 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16002 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16003 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16004 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16005 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16006 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16007 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16008 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16009 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16010 printable sample types.
16011
16012 Example:
16013 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016014
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016015digest(<algorithm>)
16016 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16017 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16018
16019 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16020 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16021
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016022div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016023 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16024 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016025 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016026 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16027 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016028 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016029 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16030 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16031 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16032 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016033 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016034 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016035
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016036djb2([<avalanche>])
16037 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16038 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16039 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16040 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16041 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16042 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16043 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016044 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16045 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016046
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016047even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016048 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016049 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16050
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016051field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16052 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16053 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16054 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16055 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16056 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16057 fields.
16058
16059 Example :
16060 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16061 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16062 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16063 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16064 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016065
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016066fix_is_valid
16067 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16068 Information eXchange):
16069
16070 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16071 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016072 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016073 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016074 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016075 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16076 checksum
16077
16078 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16079 the server can be parsed.
16080
16081 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16082 message, false if not.
16083
16084 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16085
16086 Example:
16087 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16088 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16089
16090fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16091 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16092 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16093 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16094 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016095 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016096 added.
16097
16098 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16099 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16100 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16101 fix_is_valid converter.
16102
16103 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16104
16105 Example:
16106 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16107 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16108 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16109 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16110 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16111
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016112hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016113 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016114 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016115 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016116 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016117
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016118hex2i
16119 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016120 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016121
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016122htonl
16123 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16124 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16125 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16126 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16127
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016128hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016129 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16130 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16131 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16132 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16133
16134 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16135 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16136
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016137http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016138 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16139 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016140 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16141 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16142 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16143 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16144 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16145 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16146 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16147 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016149iif(<true>,<false>)
16150 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16151 string otherwise.
16152
16153 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016154 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016155
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016156in_table(<table>)
16157 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16158 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16159 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016160 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016161 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16162
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016163ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016164 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016165 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016166 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16167 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16168 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16169 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16170 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016171
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016172json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016173 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016174 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016175 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016176 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16177 of errors:
16178 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16179 bytes, ...)
16180 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16181 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16182
16183 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16184 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16185 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16186 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16187 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16188 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016189 - "ascii" : never fails;
16190 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16191 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016192 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016193 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016194 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16195 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16196
16197 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016198 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016199
16200 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016201 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016202 capture request header user-agent len 150
16203 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016204
16205 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16206 GET / HTTP/1.0
16207 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16208
16209 Output log:
16210 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16211
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016212json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16213 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16214 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16215 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16216 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16217
16218 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16219 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16220
16221 Example:
16222 # get a integer value from the request body
16223 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16224 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16225
16226 # get a key with '.' in the name
16227 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16228 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16229
16230 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16231 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16232
16233 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16234 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16235
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016236language(<value>[,<default>])
16237 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16238 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16239 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16240 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16241 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16242 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16243 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16244 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16245 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016246 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016247 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16248 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016249
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016250 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016251
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016252 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16253 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016254
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016255 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16256 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16257 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16258 use_backend spanish if es
16259 use_backend french if fr
16260 use_backend english if en
16261 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016262
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016263length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016264 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16265 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16266 type. The result is of type integer.
16267
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016268lower
16269 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16270 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16271 type. The result is of type string.
16272
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016273ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16274 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16275 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16276 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16277 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16278 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16279 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16280
16281 Example :
16282
16283 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016284 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016285 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16286
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016287ltrim(<chars>)
16288 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16289 representation of the input sample.
16290
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016291map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16292map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16293map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16294 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16295 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16296 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16297 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16298 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16299 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16300 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16301 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016302
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016303 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16304 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16305 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016306
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016307 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016308 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016309
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016310 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16311 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16312 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16313 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016314 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16315 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016316 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16317 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16318 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16319 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16320 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16321 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16322 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16323 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016324 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16325 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16326 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016327 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16328 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16329 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16330 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16331 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016332
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016333 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16334 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16335 the corresponding match text.
16336
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016337 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16338 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16339 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16340 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16341 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016342
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016343 Example :
16344
16345 # this is a comment and is ignored
16346 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16347 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16348 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16349 | | | `---------- value
16350 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16351 | `---------------------------- key
16352 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16353
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016354mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016355 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16356 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016357 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016358 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016359 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016360 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16361 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16362 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16363 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016364 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016365 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016366
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016367mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016368 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16369 <packettype>.
16370 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16371 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16372 from.
16373 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16374 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16375 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16376
16377 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16378 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16379 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16380 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16381
16382 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16383 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16384 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16385 packets only):
16386 17: Session Expiry Interval
16387 33: Receive Maximum
16388 39: Maximum Packet Size
16389 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16390 25: Request Response Information
16391 23: Request Problem Information
16392 21: Authentication Method
16393 22: Authentication Data
16394 18: Will Delay Interval
16395 1: Payload Format Indicator
16396 2: Message Expiry Interval
16397 3: Content Type
16398 8: Response Topic
16399 9: Correlation Data
16400 Not supported yet:
16401 38: User Property
16402
16403 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16404 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16405 packets only):
16406 17: Session Expiry Interval
16407 33: Receive Maximum
16408 36: Maximum QoS
16409 37: Retain Available
16410 39: Maximum Packet Size
16411 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16412 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16413 31: Reason String
16414 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16415 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16416 42: Shared Subscription Available
16417 19: Server Keep Alive
16418 26: Response Information
16419 28: Server Reference
16420 21: Authentication Method
16421 22: Authentication Data
16422 Not supported yet:
16423 38: User Property
16424
16425 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16426 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16427 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16428 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16429
16430 Example:
16431
16432 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16433 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16434 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16435 if data_in_buffer
16436 # do the same as above
16437 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16438 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16439 if data_in_buffer
16440
16441mqtt_is_valid
16442 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16443
16444 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16445 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16446 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16447 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16448
16449 Example:
16450
16451 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16452 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16453
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016454mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016455 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016456 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16457 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016458 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016459 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016460 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016461 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16462 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16463 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16464 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016465 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016466 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016467
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016468nbsrv
16469 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16470 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16471 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16472 map lookup.
16473
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016474neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016475 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16476 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16477 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16478 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016479
16480not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016481 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016482 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016483 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016484 absence of a flag).
16485
16486odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016487 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016488 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16489
16490or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016491 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016492 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016493 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16494 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016495 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016496 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16497 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16498 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16499 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016500 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016501 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016502
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016503protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16504 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16505 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16506 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16507 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16508 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16509 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16510 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16511 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16512 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16513 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16514 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16515
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016516regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016517 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16518 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16519 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16520 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16521 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16522 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16523 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16524 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16525 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016526 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16527 of characters with other ones.
16528
16529 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16530 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16531 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16532 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16533 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16534 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016535
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016536 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016537
16538 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16539 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16540 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016541 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016542
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016543 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16544 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16545
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016546 # capture groups and backreferences
16547 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016548 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016549 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16550
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016551capture-req(<id>)
16552 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16553 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16554
16555 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016556 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16557 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016558
16559capture-res(<id>)
16560 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16561 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16562
16563 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016564 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16565 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016566
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016567rtrim(<chars>)
16568 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16569 of the input sample.
16570
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016571sdbm([<avalanche>])
16572 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16573 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16574 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16575 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16576 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16577 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16578 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016579 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16580 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016581
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016582secure_memcmp(<var>)
16583 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16584 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16585 match.
16586
16587 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16588 performed in constant time.
16589
16590 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16591 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16592
16593 Example :
16594
16595 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16596 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16597 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16598 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16599
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016600set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016601 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16602 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16603 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016604 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016605 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16606 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016607 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016608 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16609 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016610 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016611 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016612
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016613sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016614 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016615 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16616
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016617sha2([<bits>])
16618 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16619 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16620
16621 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16622 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16623
16624 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16625 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16626
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016627srv_queue
16628 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16629 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16630 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16631 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16632 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16633
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016634strcmp(<var>)
16635 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16636 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16637 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16638 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16639 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16640 shorter).
16641
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016642 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16643 strings in constant time.
16644
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016645 Example :
16646
16647 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16648 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16649 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16650
16651
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016652sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016653 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16654 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016655 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016656 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16657 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016658 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016659 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16660 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016661 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016662 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16663 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016664 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016665 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016666
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016667table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16668 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16669 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16670 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16671 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16672 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16673 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16674
16675
16676table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16677 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16678 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16679 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16680 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16681 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16682 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16683
16684table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16685 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16686 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016687 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016688 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16689 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16690
16691table_conn_cur(<table>)
16692 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16693 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16694 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16695 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16696 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16697
16698table_conn_rate(<table>)
16699 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16700 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16701 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16702 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16703 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16704
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016705table_gpt0(<table>)
16706 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16707 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16708 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16709 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16710 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16711
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016712table_gpc0(<table>)
16713 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16714 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16715 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16716 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16717 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16718
16719table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16720 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16721 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16722 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16723 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16724 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16725 sample fetch keyword.
16726
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016727table_gpc1(<table>)
16728 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16729 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16730 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16731 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16732 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16733
16734table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16735 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16736 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16737 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16738 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16739 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16740 sample fetch keyword.
16741
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016742table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16743 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16744 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016745 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016746 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16747 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16748
16749table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16750 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16751 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16752 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16753 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16754 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16755 keyword.
16756
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016757table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16758 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16759 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16760 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16761 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16762 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16763
16764table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16765 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16766 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16767 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16768 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16769 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16770 keyword.
16771
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016772table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16773 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16774 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016775 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016776 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16777 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16778
16779table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16780 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16781 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16782 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16783 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16784 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16785 keyword.
16786
16787table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16788 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16789 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016790 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016791 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16792 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16793 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16794 keyword.
16795
16796table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16797 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16798 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016799 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016800 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16801 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16802 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16803 keyword.
16804
16805table_server_id(<table>)
16806 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16807 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16808 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16809 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16810 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16811 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16812
16813table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16814 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16815 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016816 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016817 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16818 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16819 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16820 keyword.
16821
16822table_sess_rate(<table>)
16823 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16824 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16825 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16826 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16827 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16828 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16829 keyword.
16830
16831table_trackers(<table>)
16832 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16833 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16834 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16835 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16836 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16837 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16838 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16839 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16840 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16841 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16842
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016843ub64dec
16844 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16845 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16846 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16847
16848 Example:
16849 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16850 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16851
16852ub64enc
16853 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16854
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016855upper
16856 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16857 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16858 type. The result is of type string.
16859
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016860url_dec([<in_form>])
16861 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16862 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16863 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16864 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16865 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16866 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016867
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016868url_enc([<enc_type>])
16869 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16870 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16871 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16872 optional argument is here for future changes.
16873
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016874ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016875 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016876 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16877 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16878 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016879 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16880 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16881 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16882 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016883 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016884 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16885 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016886
16887 Example:
16888 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16889 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16890
16891 message Point {
16892 int32 latitude = 1;
16893 int32 longitude = 2;
16894 }
16895
16896 message PPoint {
16897 Point point = 59;
16898 }
16899
16900 message Rectangle {
16901 // One corner of the rectangle.
16902 PPoint lo = 48;
16903 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16904 PPoint hi = 49;
16905 }
16906
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016907 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16908 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16909 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016910
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016911 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16912 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016913 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016914 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16915
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016916 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016917
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016918 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016919
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016920 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16921 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16922 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016923
16924 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16925 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16926 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16927
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016928 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16929 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16930 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016931
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016932
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016933unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016934 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16935 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16936 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16937 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16938 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16939 response),
16940 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16941 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16942 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16943 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16944
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016945utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16946 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16947 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16948 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16949 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16950 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16951 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16952
16953 Example :
16954
16955 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016956 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016957 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16958
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016959word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16960 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16961 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16962 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016963 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016964 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16965 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16966
16967 Example :
16968 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16969 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16970 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16971 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16972 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016973 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016974
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016975wt6([<avalanche>])
16976 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16977 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16978 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16979 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16980 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16981 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16982 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016983 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16984 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016985
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016986xor(<value>)
16987 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016988 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016989 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016990 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016991 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016992 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16993 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016994 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016995 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16996 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016997 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016998 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016999
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017000xxh3([<seed>])
17001 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17002 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17003 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17004 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17005 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17006 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17007 considered as cryptographically secure.
17008
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017009xxh32([<seed>])
17010 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17011 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17012 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17013 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17014 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17015 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17016 as cryptographically secure.
17017
17018xxh64([<seed>])
17019 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17020 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17021 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17022 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17023 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17024 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17025 as cryptographically secure.
17026
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017027
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170287.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017029--------------------------------------------
17030
17031A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17032not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17033"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17034The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17035
17036always_false : boolean
17037 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17038 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17039
17040always_true : boolean
17041 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17042 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17043
17044avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017045 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017046 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17047 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17048 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17049 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17050 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17051 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17052 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17053 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17054 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17055 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17056 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17057 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17058 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017060be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017061 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17062 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17063 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17064 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017065 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17066
17067be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17068 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17069 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17070 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17071 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17072 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017073 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17074 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017075
17076 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17077 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17078 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017080be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17081 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17082 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17083 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017084 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017085 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17086 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017087
17088 Example :
17089 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17090 backend dynamic
17091 mode http
17092 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17093 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017094
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017095bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017096 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17097 of the string.
17098
17099bool(<bool>) : bool
17100 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17101 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017103connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17104 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017105 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017106 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17107 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017108
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017109 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017110 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017111 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17112
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017113 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17114 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017115
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017116 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017117 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017118 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017119 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017120 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017121 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017122 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017123
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017124 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17125 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017126 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017127 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017128
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017129cpu_calls : integer
17130 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17131 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17132 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17133 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17134 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17135 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17136
17137cpu_ns_avg : integer
17138 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17139 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17140 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17141 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17142 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17143 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17144 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17145 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17146 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17147 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17148 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17149
17150cpu_ns_tot : integer
17151 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17152 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17153 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17154 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17155 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17156 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17157 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17158 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17159 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17160 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17161 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17162 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17163 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17164
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017165date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017166 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017167
17168 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17169 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17170 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017171 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17172
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017173 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17174 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17175 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17176 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17177 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17178
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017179 Example :
17180
17181 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17182 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017183
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017184 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17185 # millisecond granularity
17186 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17187
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017188date_us : integer
17189 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17190 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17191 from the same timeval structure.
17192
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017193distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17194 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17195 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17196 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17197 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
17198 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
17199 list of supported tokens.
17200
17201distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17202 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17203 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17204 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17205 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
17206 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
17207 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17208 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17209 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17210 supported tokens.
17211
17212 Example :
17213 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17214 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17215 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17216 # send large files to the big farm
17217 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17218
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017219env(<name>) : string
17220 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17221 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17222 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17223 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17224 certain way.
17225
17226 Examples :
17227 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17228 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17229
17230 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17231 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017233fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17234 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017235 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17236 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017237 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17238 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017239 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017240 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17241 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017242
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017243fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17244 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17245 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17246 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017248fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17249 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17250 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17251 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17252 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17253 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17254 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17255 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17256 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017257
17258 Example :
17259 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17260 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17261 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17262 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17263 frontend mail
17264 bind :25
17265 mode tcp
17266 maxconn 100
17267 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17268 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17269 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17270 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017271
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017272hostname : string
17273 Returns the system hostname.
17274
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017275int(<integer>) : signed integer
17276 Returns a signed integer.
17277
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017278ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17279 Returns an ipv4.
17280
17281ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17282 Returns an ipv6.
17283
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017284lat_ns_avg : integer
17285 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17286 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17287 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17288 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17289 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17290 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17291 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17292 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17293 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017294 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17295 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17296 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17297 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17298 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17299 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017300
17301lat_ns_tot : integer
17302 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17303 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17304 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17305 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17306 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17307 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17308 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17309 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17310 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017311 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17312 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17313 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17314 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17315 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017316 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17317 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17318 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17319 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17320 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17321 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17322
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017323meth(<method>) : method
17324 Returns a method.
17325
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017326nbproc : integer
17327 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17328 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17329 and debugging purposes.
17330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017331nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17332 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17333 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17334 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017335 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17336 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17337 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017338
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017339prio_class : integer
17340 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17341 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17342 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17343
17344prio_offset : integer
17345 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17346 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17347 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17348 set-priority-offset".
17349
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017350proc : integer
17351 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17352 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17353 debugging purposes.
17354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017355queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017356 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17357 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17358 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017359 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17360 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17361 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17362 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17363 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17364
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017365rand([<range>]) : integer
17366 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17367 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17368 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17369 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17370 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17371
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017372uuid([<version>]) : string
17373 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17374 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17375 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017377srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17378 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17379 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17380 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17381 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17382 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017383 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17384 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17385
17386srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17387 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17388 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17389 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17390 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17391 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17392 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17393 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17394
17395 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17396 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017397
17398srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17399 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17400 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17401 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017402 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017403 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17404 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17405 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17406
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017407srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17408 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17409 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17410 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17411 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17412 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17413 fetch methods.
17414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017415srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17416 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17417 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017418 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017419 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17420 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017421 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017422 overloading servers).
17423
17424 Example :
17425 # Redirect to a separate back
17426 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17427 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17428 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17429
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017430srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017431 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17432 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17433 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17434
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017435srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017436 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17437 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17438 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17439
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017440srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017441 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17442 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17443 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17444
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017445stopping : boolean
17446 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17447 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17448 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17449
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017450str(<string>) : string
17451 Returns a string.
17452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017453table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17454 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17455 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17456
17457table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17458 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17459 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17460 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17461
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017462thread : integer
17463 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17464 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17465 and debugging purposes.
17466
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017467var(<var-name>) : undefined
17468 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017469 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17470 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017471 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017472 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17473 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017474 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017475 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17476 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017477 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017478 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017479
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200174807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017481----------------------------------
17482
17483The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17484closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17485methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17486sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17487TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017488the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17489counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017490"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17491used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17492can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17493Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17494table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17495tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17496currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017497
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017498bc_dst : ip
17499 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17500 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17501 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17502 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17503
17504bc_dst_port : integer
17505 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17506 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17507
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017508bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017509 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17510 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17511 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17512
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017513bc_src : ip
17514 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17515 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17516 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17517 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17518
17519bc_src_port : integer
17520 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17521 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017523be_id : integer
17524 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017525 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17526 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017527
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017528be_name : string
17529 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017530 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17531 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017532
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017533be_server_timeout : integer
17534 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17535 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17536 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17537
17538be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17539 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17540 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17541 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17542
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017543cur_server_timeout : integer
17544 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17545 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17546 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17547
17548cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17549 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17550 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17551 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017553dst : ip
17554 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17555 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17556 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17557 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017558 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17559 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17560 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17561 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17562 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17563 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017564
17565dst_conn : integer
17566 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17567 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17568 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17569 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17570 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17571 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17572 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17573 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017574
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017575dst_is_local : boolean
17576 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17577 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17578 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17579 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017580 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017581 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17582 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17583 it only once per connection.
17584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017585dst_port : integer
17586 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17587 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17588 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17589 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17590 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17591 an HTTP header.
17592
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017593fc_http_major : integer
17594 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17595 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17596 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17597
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017598fc_pp_authority : string
17599 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17600 if any.
17601
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017602fc_pp_unique_id : string
17603 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17604 if any.
17605
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017606fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17607 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17608 header.
17609
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017610fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17611 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17612 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17613 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17614 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17615 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17616 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17617
17618fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17619 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17620 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17621 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17622 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17623 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17624 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17625
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017626fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017627 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17628 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17629 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17630 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17631
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017632fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017633 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17634 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17635 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17636 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17637
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017638fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017639 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17640 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17641 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17642 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17643
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017644fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017645 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17646 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17647 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17648 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17649
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017650fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017651 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17652 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17653 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17654 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17655
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017656fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017657 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17658 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17659 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17660 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17661
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017662fe_defbe : string
17663 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17664 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017666fe_id : integer
17667 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017668 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017669 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17670
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017671fe_name : string
17672 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17673 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17674 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17675
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017676fe_client_timeout : integer
17677 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17678 current frontend.
17679
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017680sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017681sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17682sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17683sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017684 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17685 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17686 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17687
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017688sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017689sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17690sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17691sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017692 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17693 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17694 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17695
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017696sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017697sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17698sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17699sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017700 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17701 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017702 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17703 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17704 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017705
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017706 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017707 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17708 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017709 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17710 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17711 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017712 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17713 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17714
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017715sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17716sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17717sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17718sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17719 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17720 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17721 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17722 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17723 when a first ACL was verified.
17724
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017725sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017726sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17727sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17728sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017729 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017730 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17731
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017732sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017733sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17734sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17735sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017736 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17737 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17738 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17739
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017740sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017741sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17742sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17743sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017744 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17745 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17746 See also src_conn_rate.
17747
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017748sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017749sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17750sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17751sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017752 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017753 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017754
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017755sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17756sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17757sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17758sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17759 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17760 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17761
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017762sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17763sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17764sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17765sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17766 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17767 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17768
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017769sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017770sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17771sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17772sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017773 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17774 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17775 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017776 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17777 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17778 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017779
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017780sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17781sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17782sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17783sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17784 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17785 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17786 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17787 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17788 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17789 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17790
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017791sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017792sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17793sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17794sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017795 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017796 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17797 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17798
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017799sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017800sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17801sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17802sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017803 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17804 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17805 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17806 src_http_err_rate.
17807
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017808sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17809sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17810sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17811sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17812 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17813 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17814 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17815
17816sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17817sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17818sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17819sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17820 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17821 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17822 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17823 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17824
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017825sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017826sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17827sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17828sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017829 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017830 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17831 src_http_req_cnt.
17832
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017833sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017834sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17835sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17836sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017837 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17838 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17839 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17840 src_http_req_rate.
17841
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017842sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017843sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17844sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17845sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017846 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017847 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17848 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17849 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17850 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017851
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017852 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017853 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17854 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017855 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17856
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017857sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17858sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17859sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17860sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17861 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17862 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17863 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17864 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17865 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17866
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017867sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017868sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17869sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17870sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017871 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17872 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17873 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017874
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017875sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017876sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17877sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17878sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017879 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17880 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17881 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017882
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017883sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017884sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17885sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17886sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017887 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017888 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17889 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17890 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017891 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017892 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17893
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017894sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017895sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17896sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17897sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017898 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17899 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17900 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17901 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17902 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017903 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017904
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017905sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017906sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17907sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17908sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017909 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17910 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17911 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17912
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017913sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017914sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17915sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17916sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017917 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17918 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017919 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017920 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17921 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017922 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17923 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17924 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017926so_id : integer
17927 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17928 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17929 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017930
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017931so_name : string
17932 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17933 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17934 strings instead of integers.
17935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017936src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017937 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017938 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17939 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17940 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017941 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17942 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17943 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017944 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17945 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17946 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17947 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17948 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17949 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17950 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017951
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017952 Example:
17953 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17954 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017956src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17957 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17958 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17959 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017960 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017962src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17963 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17964 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017965 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017966 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017968src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17969 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17970 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17971 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17972 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17973 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17974 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017975
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017976 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017977 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17978 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17979 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17980 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017981 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017982 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17983 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17984
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017985src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17986 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17987 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17988 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17989 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17990 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17991 was verified.
17992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017993src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017994 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017995 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017996 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017997 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017999src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018000 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018001 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18002 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018003 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018005src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18006 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18007 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18008 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018009 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018011src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018012 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018013 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018014 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018015 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018016
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018017src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18018 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18019 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18020 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18021 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18022
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018023src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18024 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18025 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18026 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18027 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018029src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018030 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018031 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018032 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18033 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018034 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18035 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18036 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018037
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018038src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18039 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18040 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18041 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18042 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18043 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18044 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18045 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018047src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018048 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018049 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018050 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018051 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018052 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018054src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18055 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18056 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18057 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18058 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018059 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018060
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018061src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18062 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18063 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018064 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018065 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18066 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18067
18068src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18069 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18070 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18071 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18072 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18073 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18074 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018076src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018077 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018078 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18079 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018080 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018082src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18083 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18084 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18085 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018086 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018087 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018089src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18090 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18091 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18092 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018093 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018094 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18095 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018096
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018097 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018098 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018099 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018100 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018101
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018102src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18103 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18104 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18105 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18106 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18107 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18108 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18109
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018110src_is_local : boolean
18111 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18112 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18113 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18114 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018115 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018116 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18117 once per connection.
18118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018119src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018120 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18121 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18122 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18123 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18124 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018126src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018127 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18128 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18129 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18130 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18131 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018133src_port : integer
18134 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18135 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18136 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18137 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018139src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018140 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018141 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18142 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18143 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018144 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018146src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18147 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18148 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18149 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18150 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018151 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018153src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18154 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18155 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18156 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18157 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18158 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18159 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18160 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18161 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018162
18163 Example :
18164 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18165 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18166 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18167 listen ssh
18168 bind :22
18169 mode tcp
18170 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018171 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018172 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018173 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018175srv_id : integer
18176 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18177 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018178 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018179
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018180srv_name : string
18181 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18182 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018183 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018184
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200181857.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018186----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018188The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
18189closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18190when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18191usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018192future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018193
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001819451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18195 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18196 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18197 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18198 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18199 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18200
18201 Example :
18202 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18203 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18204 # the request.
18205 frontend http-in
18206 bind *:8081
18207 default_backend servers
18208 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18209 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18210
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018211ssl_bc : boolean
18212 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18213 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018214 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18215 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018216
18217ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18218 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018219 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18220 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018221
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018222ssl_bc_alpn : string
18223 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18224 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018225 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018226 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18227 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18228 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18229 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18230 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018231 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18232 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018233
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018234ssl_bc_cipher : string
18235 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018236 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18237 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018238
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018239ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18240 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18241 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18242 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018243 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018244
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018245ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18246 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18247 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018248 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18249 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018250
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018251ssl_bc_npn : string
18252 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18253 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018254 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018255 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18256 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18257 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18258 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018259 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18260 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018261
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018262ssl_bc_protocol : string
18263 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018264 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18265 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018266
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018267ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018268 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018269 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018270 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18271 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018272
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018273ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18274 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18275 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18276 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018277 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018278
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018279ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18280 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18281 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018282 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18283 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018284
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018285ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18286 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18287 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18288 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018289 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018290
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018291ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18292 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018293 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18294 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018296ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18297 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18298 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18299 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18300 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18301 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018303ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18304 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18305 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18306 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18307 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018308
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018309ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018310 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18311 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18312 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018313 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018314 does not support resumed sessions.
18315
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018316ssl_c_der : binary
18317 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18318 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18319 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018321ssl_c_err : integer
18322 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18323 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18324 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18325 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18326 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018327
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018328ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018329 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18330 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18331 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18332 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18333 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18334 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18335 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18336 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018337 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18338 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18339 LDAP v3.
18340 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18341 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018343ssl_c_key_alg : string
18344 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18345 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18346 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018348ssl_c_notafter : string
18349 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18350 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18351 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018353ssl_c_notbefore : string
18354 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18355 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18356 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018357
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018358ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018359 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18360 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18361 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18362 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18363 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18364 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18365 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18366 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018367 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18368 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18369 LDAP v3.
18370 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18371 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018373ssl_c_serial : binary
18374 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18375 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18376 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18379 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18380 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18381 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018382 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18383 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18384
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018385 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018386 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018388ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18389 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18390 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18391 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018393ssl_c_used : boolean
18394 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18395 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018397ssl_c_verify : integer
18398 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18399 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18400 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18401 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018403ssl_c_version : integer
18404 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18405 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018406
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018407ssl_f_der : binary
18408 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18409 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18410 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18411
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018412ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018413 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18414 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18415 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18416 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018417 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018418 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18419 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18420 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018421 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18422 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18423 LDAP v3.
18424 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18425 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018427ssl_f_key_alg : string
18428 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18429 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18430 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018432ssl_f_notafter : string
18433 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18434 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18435 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018437ssl_f_notbefore : string
18438 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18439 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18440 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018441
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018442ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018443 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18444 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18445 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18446 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18447 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18448 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18449 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18450 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018451 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18452 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18453 LDAP v3.
18454 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18455 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018457ssl_f_serial : binary
18458 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18459 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18460 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018461
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018462ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18463 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18464 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18465 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018467ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18468 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18469 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18470 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018472ssl_f_version : integer
18473 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18474 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18475
18476ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018477 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18478 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18479 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018481 Example :
18482 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18483 listen http-https
18484 bind :80
18485 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18486 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18487
18488ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18489 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18490 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18491
18492ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018493 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018494 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18495 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18496 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18497 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18498 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18499 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18500 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18501 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018503ssl_fc_cipher : string
18504 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18505 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018506
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018507ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18508 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18509 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018510 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018511
18512ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18513 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18514 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018515 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018516
18517ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18518 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18519 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18520 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018521 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018522 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018523
18524ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18525 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18526 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018527 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018528
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018529ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18530 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18531 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18532 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18533
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018534ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18535 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18536 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18537 transport layer.
18538 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18539 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18540 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18541 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18542
18543ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18544 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18545 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18546 transport layer.
18547 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18548 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18549 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18550 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18551
18552ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18553 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18554 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18555 transport layer.
18556 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18557 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18558 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18559 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18560
18561ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18562 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18563 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18564 transport layer.
18565 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18566 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18567 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18568 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18569
18570ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18571 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18572 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18573 transport layer.
18574 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18575 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18576 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18577 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018579ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018580 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18581 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018582 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18583 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18584 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18585 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018586
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018587ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18588 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18589 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18590 wait until the handshake happened.
18591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018592ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18593 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018594 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18595 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018596 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018597 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018598
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018599ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018600 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018601 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18602 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018604ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018605 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018606 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18607 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18608 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18609 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18610 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18611 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18612 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018614ssl_fc_protocol : string
18615 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18616 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018617
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018618ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018619 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018620 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18621 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018622
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018623ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18624 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18625 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18626 transport layer.
18627 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18628 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18629 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18630 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18631
18632ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18633 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18634 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18635 transport layer.
18636 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18637 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18638 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18639 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18640
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018641ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18642 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18643 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18644 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018646ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18647 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18648 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18649 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18650 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018651
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018652ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18653 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18654 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18655 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18656 BoringSSL.
18657
18658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018659ssl_fc_sni : string
18660 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18661 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18662 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18663 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18664 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18665
18666 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18667 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18668 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018669 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018670 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018672 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018673 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18674 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018676ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18677 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18678 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018679
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018680ssl_s_der : binary
18681 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18682 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18683 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18684
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018685ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18686 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18687 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18688 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018689 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018690 does not support resumed sessions.
18691
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018692ssl_s_key_alg : string
18693 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18694 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18695 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18696
18697ssl_s_notafter : string
18698 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18699 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18700 transport layer.
18701
18702ssl_s_notbefore : string
18703 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18704 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18705 transport layer.
18706
18707ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18708 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18709 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18710 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18711 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18712 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18713 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018714 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18715 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018716 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18717 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18718 LDAP v3.
18719 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18720 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18721
18722ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18723 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18724 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18725 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18726 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18727 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18728 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018729 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18730 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018731 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18732 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18733 LDAP v3.
18734 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18735 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18736
18737ssl_s_serial : binary
18738 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18739 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18740 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18741
18742ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18743 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18744 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18745 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18746
18747ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18748 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18749 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18750 layer.
18751
18752ssl_s_version : integer
18753 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18754 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018755
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200187567.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018757------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018759Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18760sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18761only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18762For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18763be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18764can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18765sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18766for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18767content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018768
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018769Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18770 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18771 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18772 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18773 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18774 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18775 sample expression). So be careful.
18776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018777payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018778 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018779 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18780 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018782payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18783 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018784 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018785 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018787req.len : integer
18788req_len : integer (deprecated)
18789 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18790 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18791 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18792 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18793 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18794 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18795 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18796 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018798req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18799 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018800 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18801 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18802 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18803 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018805 ACL alternatives :
18806 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018808req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18809 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18810 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18811 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18812 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018814 ACL alternatives :
18815 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018817 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018819req.proto_http : boolean
18820req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18821 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18822 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18823 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18824 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18825 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18826 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18827 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018829 Example:
18830 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18831 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18832 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018833 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018835req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18836rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18837 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18838 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18839 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18840 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18841 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18842 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18843 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018845 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18846 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18847 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18848 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18849 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18850 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018852 ACL derivatives :
18853 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018855 Example :
18856 listen tse-farm
18857 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18858 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18859 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18860 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18861 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18862 persist rdp-cookie
18863 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18864 # This is only useful makes sense if
18865 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18866 stick-table type string size 204800
18867 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18868 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18869 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018871 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18872 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018874req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18875rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18876 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18877 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18878 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18879 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018881 ACL derivatives :
18882 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018883
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018884req.ssl_alpn : string
18885 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18886 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18887 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18888 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18889 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18890 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018891 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018892
18893 Examples :
18894 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18895 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18896 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018897 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018898 default_backend bk_default
18899
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018900req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18901 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18902 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018903 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18904 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18905 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18906 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18907 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018909req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18910req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18911 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18912 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18913 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18914 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18915 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18916 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18917 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018919req.ssl_sni : string
18920req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18921 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18922 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18923 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18924 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18925 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018926 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18927 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18928 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18929 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18930 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18931 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18932 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18933 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18934 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018936 ACL derivatives :
18937 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018939 Examples :
18940 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18941 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18942 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18943 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18944 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018945
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018946req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18947 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18948 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18949 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18950 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18951 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18952 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18953 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18954 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18955 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018957req.ssl_ver : integer
18958req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18959 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18960 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18961 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18962 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18963 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18964 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18965 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018966 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018967 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018969 ACL derivatives :
18970 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018971
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018972res.len : integer
18973 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18974 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18975 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18976 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18977 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18978 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18979 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018980 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018982res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18983 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018984 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018985 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018986 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018987 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018989res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18990 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18991 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18992 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018993 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18994 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018996 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018997
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018998res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18999rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19000 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19001 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19002 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19003 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19004 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19005 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19006 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019008wait_end : boolean
19009 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19010 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019011 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019012 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19013 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019014 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019015 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19016 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019018 Examples :
19019 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19020 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19021 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019023 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19024 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19025 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19026 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19027 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19028 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19029 tcp-request content reject
19030
19031
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190327.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019033--------------------------------------
19034
19035It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19036This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19037data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19038its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19039HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19040content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19041to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19042more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19043response are indexed.
19044
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019045Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19046 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19047 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19048 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19049 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19050 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19051 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019053base : string
19054 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19055 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19056 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19057 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19058 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19059 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19060 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19061 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19062
19063 ACL derivatives :
19064 base : exact string match
19065 base_beg : prefix match
19066 base_dir : subdir match
19067 base_dom : domain match
19068 base_end : suffix match
19069 base_len : length match
19070 base_reg : regex match
19071 base_sub : substring match
19072
19073base32 : integer
19074 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19075 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19076 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019077 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19078 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19079 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019080
19081base32+src : binary
19082 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19083 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19084 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19085 per-URL counters.
19086
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019087baseq : string
19088 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19089 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19090 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19091 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19092
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019093capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19094 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19095 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19096 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19097
19098capture.req.method : string
19099 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19100 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19101 because it's allocated.
19102
19103capture.req.uri : string
19104 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19105 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19106 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19107 allocated.
19108
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019109capture.req.ver : string
19110 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19111 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19112 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19113
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019114capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19115 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19116 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19117 The first entry is an index of 0.
19118 See also: "capture response header"
19119
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019120capture.res.ver : string
19121 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19122 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19123 persistent flag.
19124
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019125req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019126 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19127 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19128 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019129
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019130req.body_param([<name>) : string
19131 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19132 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19133 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19134 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19135 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19136 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19137 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19138 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19139 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19140 given.
19141
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019142req.body_len : integer
19143 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19144 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019145 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19146 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019147
19148req.body_size : integer
19149 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019150 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19151 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019153req.cook([<name>]) : string
19154cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19155 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19156 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19157 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19158 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19159 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19160 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19161 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19162 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19163
19164 ACL derivatives :
19165 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19166 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19167 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19168 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19169 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19170 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19171 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19172 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019174req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19175cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19176 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19177 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019179req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19180cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19181 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19182 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19183 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19184 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019186cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19187 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19188 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19189 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19190 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019191 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019192 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19193 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19194 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19195 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019197hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19198 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19199 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19200 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19201 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019202 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019204req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019205 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19206 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19207 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19208 with headers such as User-Agent.
19209
19210 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19211 found.
19212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019213 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19214 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19215 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019216 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019218req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19219 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19220 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019221 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19222 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019224req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019225 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19226 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19227 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19228 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19229 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19230 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19231 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19232
19233 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19234 found.
19235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019236 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19237 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19238 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019239 with -1 being the last one.
19240
19241 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19242 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019244 ACL derivatives :
19245 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19246 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19247 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19248 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19249 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19250 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19251 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19252 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19253
19254req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19255hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19256 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19257 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019258 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19259 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19260 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19261
19262 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19263 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19264 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19265
19266 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019267
19268req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19269hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19270 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19271 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19272 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019273 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19274 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19275 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19276 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19277 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019278
19279 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19280
19281 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019282
19283req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19284hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19285 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19286 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19287 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019288
19289 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19290
19291 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019292
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019293req.hdrs : string
19294 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19295 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19296 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19297 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19298
19299req.hdrs_bin : binary
19300 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19301 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19302 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19303 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19304 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19305 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19306
19307 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019308
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019309 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19310 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019312http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19313 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19314 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19315 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19316 basic auth is supported.
19317
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019318http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19319 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19320 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19321 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19322 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019323 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19324 basic auth is supported.
19325
19326 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019327 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19328 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19329 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19330 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019331
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019332http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019333 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19334 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19335 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019336
19337http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019338 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19339 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19340 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019341
19342http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019343 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19344 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19345 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019347http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019348 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19349 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019350 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19351 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019353method : integer + string
19354 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19355 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19356 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19357 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19358 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19359 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19360 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019362 ACL derivatives :
19363 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019365 Example :
19366 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19367 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19368 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019370path : string
19371 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19372 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19373 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19374 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19375 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019376 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019377 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019379 ACL derivatives :
19380 path : exact string match
19381 path_beg : prefix match
19382 path_dir : subdir match
19383 path_dom : domain match
19384 path_end : suffix match
19385 path_len : length match
19386 path_reg : regex match
19387 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019388
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019389pathq : string
19390 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19391 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19392 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19393 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19394 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19395 result in both cases.
19396
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019397query : string
19398 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19399 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19400 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19401 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019402 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019403 which stops before the question mark.
19404
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019405req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19406 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19407 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19408 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19409 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019411req.ver : string
19412req_ver : string (deprecated)
19413 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19414 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19415 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019417 ACL derivatives :
19418 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019419
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019420res.body : binary
19421 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19422 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019423 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19424
19425 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019426
19427res.body_len : integer
19428 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19429 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019430 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19431
19432 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019433
19434res.body_size : integer
19435 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19436 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19437 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19438 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019439 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19440
19441 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019442
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019443res.cache_hit : boolean
19444 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19445 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19446
19447res.cache_name : string
19448 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19449 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19450 empty string.
19451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019452res.comp : boolean
19453 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19454 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19455 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019457res.comp_algo : string
19458 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19459 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19460 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019462res.cook([<name>]) : string
19463scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19464 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19465 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019466 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19467
19468 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019470 ACL derivatives :
19471 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019473res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19474scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19475 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19476 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019477 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19478
19479 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019481res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19482scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19483 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19484 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019485 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19486
19487 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019489res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019490 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19491 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19492
19493 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19494 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19495
19496 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19497
19498 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019500res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019501 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19502 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19503
19504 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19505 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19506
19507 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019509res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19510shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019511 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19512 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19513
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019514 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019515 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19516
19517 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019519 ACL derivatives :
19520 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19521 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19522 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19523 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19524 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19525 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19526 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19527 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19528
19529res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19530shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019531 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19532 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19533
19534 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019535 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019536
19537 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019539res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19540shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019541 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19542 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19543
19544 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19545
19546 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019547
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019548res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19549 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19550 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19551 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019552 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19553
19554 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019556res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19557shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019558 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19559 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19560
19561 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19562
19563 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019564
19565res.hdrs : string
19566 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19567 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19568 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019569 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19570
19571 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019572
19573res.hdrs_bin : binary
19574 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19575 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19576 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19577 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19578 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19579 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19580 (length of 0 for both).
19581
19582 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19583
19584 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19585 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019587res.ver : string
19588resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19589 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019590 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19591
19592 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019594 ACL derivatives :
19595 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019597set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19598 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19599 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019600 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019601 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019603 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19604 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019606status : integer
19607 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19608 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019609 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19610
19611 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019612
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019613unique-id : string
19614 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19615 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19616 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19617 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19618 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19619 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019621url : string
19622 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19623 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19624 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19625 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19626 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19627 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19628 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019630 ACL derivatives :
19631 url : exact string match
19632 url_beg : prefix match
19633 url_dir : subdir match
19634 url_dom : domain match
19635 url_end : suffix match
19636 url_len : length match
19637 url_reg : regex match
19638 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019640url_ip : ip
19641 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19642 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19643 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19644 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19645 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19646 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19647 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019649url_port : integer
19650 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19651 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19652 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19653 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019654
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019655urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19656url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019657 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19658 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019659 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19660 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19661 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19662 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019663 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19664 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019665 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19666 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019668 ACL derivatives :
19669 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19670 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19671 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19672 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19673 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19674 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19675 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19676 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019677
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019679 Example :
19680 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19681 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19682 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19683 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019684
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019685urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019686 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19687 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19688 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019689
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019690url32 : integer
19691 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19692 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19693 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19694 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19695 is an unsigned integer.
19696
19697url32+src : binary
19698 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19699 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19700 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19701
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019702
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200197037.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019704---------------------------------------
19705
19706This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19707used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19708purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19709There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19710or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19711any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19712for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19713
19714internal.htx.data : integer
19715 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19716 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19717
19718internal.htx.free : integer
19719 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19720 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19721
19722internal.htx.free_data : integer
19723 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19724 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19725
19726internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019727 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19728 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19729 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019730
19731internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19732 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19733 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19734
19735internal.htx.size : integer
19736 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19737 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19738
19739internal.htx.used : integer
19740 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19741 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19742 direction.
19743
19744internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19745 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19746 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19747 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19748 of the special value :
19749 * head : The oldest inserted block
19750 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019751 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019752
19753internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19754 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19755 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19756 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19757 integer or one of the special value :
19758 * head : The oldest inserted block
19759 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019760 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019761
19762internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19763 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19764 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19765 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19766 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19767
19768 * head : The oldest inserted block
19769 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019770 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019771
19772internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19773 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19774 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19775 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19776 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19777
19778 * head : The oldest inserted block
19779 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019780 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019781
19782internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19783 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19784 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19785 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19786 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19787
19788 * head : The oldest inserted block
19789 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019790 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019791
19792internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19793 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19794 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19795 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19796 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19797
19798 * head : The oldest inserted block
19799 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019800 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019801
19802internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19803 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19804 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19805 it returns false.
19806
19807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200198087.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019809---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019810
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019811Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19812every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019813order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019815ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019816---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19817FALSE always_false never match
19818HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19819HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19820HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019821HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019822HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19823HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19824HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19825HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19826LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19827METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19828METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19829METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19830METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19831METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19832METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19833METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19834METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19835RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19836REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19837TRUE always_true always match
19838WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19839---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019840
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198428. Logging
19843----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019844
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019845One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19846provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19847very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19848provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19849state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019850to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019851headers.
19852
19853In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19854about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19855send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19856
19857 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19858 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19859 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19860 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19861 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019862 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019863 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019864
19865The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19866allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19867as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19868while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19869real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19870delay.
19871
19872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198738.1. Log levels
19874---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019875
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019876TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019877source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019878HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19879in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19880track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19881syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19882about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019883
19884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198858.2. Log formats
19886----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019887
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019888HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019889and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19890slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19891options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019892
19893 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19894 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19895 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19896 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19897 extents.
19898
19899 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19900 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19901 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19902 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19903 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19904
19905 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19906 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19907 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19908 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19909 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19910
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019911 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19912 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19913 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19914 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19915
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019916 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19917
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019918Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19919specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19920field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19921servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19922always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19923identifier.
19924
19925Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19926 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19927 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19928 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19929 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19930
19931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199328.2.1. Default log format
19933-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019934
19935This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19936as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19937format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19938
19939 Example :
19940 listen www
19941 mode http
19942 log global
19943 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19944
19945 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19946 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19947 (www/HTTP)
19948
19949 Field Format Extract from the example above
19950 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19951 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19952 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19953 4 'to' to
19954 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19955 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19956
19957Detailed fields description :
19958 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19959 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19960 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19961 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19962 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19963 and processed the connection.
19964 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19965
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019966In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19967"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19968connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19969
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019970It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19971will eventually disappear.
19972
19973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199748.2.2. TCP log format
19975---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019976
19977The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19978is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19979information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19980counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19981emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19982environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19983the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19984sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019985specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19986not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19987fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19988marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019989
19990 Example :
19991 frontend fnt
19992 mode tcp
19993 option tcplog
19994 log global
19995 default_backend bck
19996
19997 backend bck
19998 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19999
20000 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20001 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20002 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20003
20004 Field Format Extract from the example above
20005 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20006 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20007 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20008 4 frontend_name fnt
20009 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20010 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20011 7 bytes_read* 212
20012 8 termination_state --
20013 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20014 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20015
20016Detailed fields description :
20017 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020018 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20019 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20020 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020021 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020022 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020023 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020024
20025 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020026 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20027 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20028 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020029
20030 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
20031 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20032 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020033 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20034 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20035 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20036 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020037
20038 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20039 and processed the connection.
20040
20041 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20042 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20043 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20044 applications.
20045
20046 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20047 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20048 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20049 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20050 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20051
20052 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20053 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20054 See "Timers" below for more details.
20055
20056 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20057 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20058 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20059 "Timers" below for more details.
20060
20061 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020062 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020063 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20064 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20065 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20066 details.
20067
20068 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20069 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20070 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20071 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20072 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20073
20074 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20075 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20076 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20077 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20078 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20079 for more details.
20080
20081 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020082 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020083 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20084 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20085 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020086 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020087
20088 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20089 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20090 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20091 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20092 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20093 caused by a denial of service attack.
20094
20095 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20096 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20097 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20098 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20099 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20100 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20101 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20102 denial of service attack.
20103
20104 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20105 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20106 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20107 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20108 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20109 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20110 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20111 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20112 be processed than on other servers.
20113
20114 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20115 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20116 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20117 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20118 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20119 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20120 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20121 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20122 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20123 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20124 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20125 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20126 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20127
20128 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20129 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20130 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20131 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20132 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20133 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020134 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020135 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20136
20137 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20138 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20139 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20140 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20141 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20142 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020143 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020144 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20145 occurs.
20146
20147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201488.2.3. HTTP log format
20149----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020150
20151The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20152is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20153the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20154are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20155emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20156generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20157"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20158which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020159frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20160is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020161
20162Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20163slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20164with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20165
20166 Example :
20167 frontend http-in
20168 mode http
20169 option httplog
20170 log global
20171 default_backend bck
20172
20173 backend static
20174 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20175
20176 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20177 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20178 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020179 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020180
20181 Field Format Extract from the example above
20182 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20183 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020184 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020185 4 frontend_name http-in
20186 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020187 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020188 7 status_code 200
20189 8 bytes_read* 2750
20190 9 captured_request_cookie -
20191 10 captured_response_cookie -
20192 11 termination_state ----
20193 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20194 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20195 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20196 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20197 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020198
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020199Detailed fields description :
20200 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020201 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20202 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20203 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020204 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020205 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020206 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020207
20208 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020209 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20210 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20211 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020212
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020213 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
20214 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020215
20216 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20217 and processed the connection.
20218
20219 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20220 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20221 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20222
20223 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20224 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20225 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20226 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20227 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20228 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20229
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020230 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20231 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20232 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020233 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020234 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20235 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020236 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20237 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020238
20239 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20240 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020241 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020242
20243 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20244 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020245 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20246 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020247
20248 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20249 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20250 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20251 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20252 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020253 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20254 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020255
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020256 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20257 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20258 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20259 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20260 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20261 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20262 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020263 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020264
20265 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20266 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20267 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20268
20269 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20270 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020271 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020272 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20273 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20274 overflowing.
20275
20276 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20277 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20278 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20279 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20280 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20281 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20282 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20283 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20284
20285 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20286 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20287 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20288 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20289 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20290 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20291 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20292 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20293
20294 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20295 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20296 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20297 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20298 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20299 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20300 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20301
20302 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020303 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020304 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20305 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20306 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020307 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020308 system.
20309
20310 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20311 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20312 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20313 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20314 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20315 caused by a denial of service attack.
20316
20317 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20318 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20319 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20320 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20321 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20322 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20323 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20324 denial of service attack.
20325
20326 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20327 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20328 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20329 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20330 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20331 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20332 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20333 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20334 processed than on other servers.
20335
20336 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20337 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20338 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20339 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20340 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20341 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20342 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20343 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20344 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20345 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20346 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20347 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20348 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20349
20350 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20351 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20352 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20353 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20354 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20355 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020356 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020357 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20358
20359 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20360 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20361 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20362 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20363 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20364 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020365 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020366 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20367 occurs.
20368
20369 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20370 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20371 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20372 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20373 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20374 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20375 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20376 cookies" below for more details.
20377
20378 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20379 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20380 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20381 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20382 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20383 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20384 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20385 and cookies" below for more details.
20386
20387 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20388 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20389 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20390 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20391 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20392 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20393 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20394 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20395
20396
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200203978.2.4. Custom log format
20398------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020399
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020400The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020401mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020402
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020403HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020404Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20405separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20406prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20407
20408Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20409variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020410("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020411
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020412If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020413as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020414less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20415the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20416
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020417Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20418"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20419delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20420preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020421
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020422Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20423'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20424https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20425such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20426
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020427Flags are :
20428 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020429 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020430 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20431 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020432
20433 Example:
20434
20435 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20436 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20437
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020438 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20439
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020440At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20441
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020442 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20443 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020444
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020445the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020446
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020447 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20448 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20449 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020450
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020451and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20452
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020453 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20454 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020455
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020456Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20457
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020458 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020459 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020460 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20461 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20462 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020463 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20464 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20465 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020466 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020467 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020468 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020469 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020470 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020471 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20472 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020473 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020474 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020475 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020476 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020477 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020478 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020479 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020480 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20481 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20482 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20483 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20484 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020485 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020486 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020487 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020488 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020489 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020490 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20491 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020492 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20493 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20494 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020495 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020496 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20497 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020498 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020499 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20500 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20501 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020502 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020503 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020504 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20505 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20506 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20507 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020508 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020509 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020510 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020511 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020512 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020513 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020514 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20515 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20516 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020517 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020518 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20519 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020520 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020521 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20522 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020523 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020524 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020525 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020526 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020527
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020528 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020529
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020530
205318.2.5. Error log format
20532-----------------------
20533
20534When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20535protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20536By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20537"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020538will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020539logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20540
20541The format looks like this :
20542
20543 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20544 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20545 Connection error during SSL handshake
20546
20547 Field Format Extract from the example above
20548 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20549 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20550 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20551 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20552 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20553
20554These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20555failures.
20556
20557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205588.3. Advanced logging options
20559-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020560
20561Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20562just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20563options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20564for more information about their usage.
20565
20566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205678.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20568------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020569
20570It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20571haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20572commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20573monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20574ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20575
20576 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20577 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20578 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20579 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20580
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020581 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20582 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020583
20584 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20585 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20586 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20587
20588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20590----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020591
20592The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20593what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20594or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020595"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020596just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20597log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20598after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20599is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20600with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20601with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20602
20603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20605------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020606
20607Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20608for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20609"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20610retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20611raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20612a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20613file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20614you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20615"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20616
20617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206188.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20619--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020620
20621Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20622multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20623them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20624"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20625logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20626error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20627and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20628too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20629useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20630alternative.
20631
20632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206338.4. Timing events
20634------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020635
20636Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20637reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20638the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20639frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020640mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20641addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20642
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020643Timings events in HTTP mode:
20644
20645 first request 2nd request
20646 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20647 t tr t tr ...
20648 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20649 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20650 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20651 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020652 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020653 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20654
20655Timings events in TCP mode:
20656
20657 TCP session
20658 |<----------------->|
20659 t t
20660 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20661 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20662 |<------ Tt ------->|
20663
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020664 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020665 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020666 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20667 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20668 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020669 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020670 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20671 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20672 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20673 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020674
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020675 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20676 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20677 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020678 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20679 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20680 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20681 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20682 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20683 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020684
20685 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20686 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20687 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20688 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20689 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20690 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20691 request typed by hand during a test.
20692
20693 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20694 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020695 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020696 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20697 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20698 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20699 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020700
20701 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20702 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20703 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20704 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20705 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20706
20707 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20708 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20709 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20710 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20711 connection never established.
20712
20713 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20714 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20715 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20716 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20717 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20718 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20719 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20720 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20721 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20722 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20723 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20724
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020725 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20726 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20727 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20728 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20729 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20730 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20731
20732 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20733
20734 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20735 "Ta" can never be negative.
20736
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020737 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20738 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020739 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20740 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020741 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020742
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020743 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020744
20745 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020746 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20747 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020748
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020749 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20750 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20751 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20752 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20753 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20754 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20755 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20756 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20757
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020758These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20759protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20760that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020761due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20762"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20763that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020764
20765Most common cases :
20766
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020767 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20768 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20769 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20770 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20771 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20772 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20773 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20774 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20775 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20776 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20777 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020778 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020779
20780 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20781 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20782 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20783 of ms on remote networks.
20784
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020785 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20786 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20787 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020788
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020789 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20790 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20791 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20792 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20793 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20794 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20795 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20796 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20797 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020798
20799Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20800
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020801 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020802 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020803 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020804
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020805 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020806 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20807 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20808
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020809 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020810 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20811 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20812 flags.
20813
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020814 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20815 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020816 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20817 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20818 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20819 the client connection was maintained open.
20820
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020821 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020822 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020823 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020824 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20825
20826
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208278.5. Session state at disconnection
20828-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020829
20830TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20831"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
208322-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20833each of which has a special meaning :
20834
20835 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20836 session to terminate :
20837
20838 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20839
20840 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20841 server explicitly refused it.
20842
20843 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20844 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20845 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20846 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020847 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020848
20849 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20850 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020851
20852 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20853 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20854 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20855 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20856 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20857
20858 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20859 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20860 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20861 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20862 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20863
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020864 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20865 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20866
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020867 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20868 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20869 backup connections when going up.
20870
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020871 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20872
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020873 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20874 send or receive data.
20875
20876 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20877 send or receive data.
20878
20879 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20880 with nothing left in the buffers.
20881
20882 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20883
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020884 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020885 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20886
20887 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20888 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20889 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20890 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20891 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20892
20893 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20894 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20895
20896 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20897 server (HTTP only).
20898
20899 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20900
20901 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20902 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20903 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20904
20905 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20906 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20907 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20908
20909 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20910
20911 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20912 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20913
20914 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20915 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20916 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20917
20918 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20919 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020920 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20921 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020922
20923 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20924 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20925 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20926 another server.
20927
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020928 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020929 server.
20930
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020931 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20932 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20933 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20934 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20935
20936 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20937 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20938 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20939 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20940
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020941 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20942 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20943 "use-server" rule).
20944
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020945 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20946
20947 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20948 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20949
20950 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20951
20952 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20953 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20954 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20955
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020956 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20957 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020958 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020959 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20960 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20961
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020962 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20963
20964 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20965 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20966
20967 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20968
20969 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20970
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020971The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20972was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020973helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20974starvation, attacks, etc...
20975
20976The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20977alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20978easier finding and understanding.
20979
20980 Flags Reason
20981
20982 -- Normal termination.
20983
20984 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20985 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20986 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20987 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20988
20989 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20990 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20991 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20992 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20993 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20994 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020995
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020996 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20997 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020998 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020999
21000 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21001 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21002 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21003
21004 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21005 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21006 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21007 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21008 the server takes too long to respond.
21009
21010 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21011 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21012 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21013 long a time to respond.
21014
21015 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21016 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21017 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
21018 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021019 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21020 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021021
21022 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21023 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21024 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21025 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21026 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021027 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021028 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21029 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21030 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21031 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21032 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21033 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21034 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21035 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021036 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021037 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21038 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21039 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021040
21041 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21042 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021043 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21044 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21045 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21046 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021047
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021048 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
21049 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021051 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021052 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21053 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021054 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021055 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21056 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21057
21058 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21059 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21060 503 or 504 here.
21061
21062 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
21063 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
21064 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21065 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21066 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21067
21068 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21069 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021070 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021071 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
21072 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
21073
21074 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21075 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21076 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21077 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21078 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21079 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
21080 between haproxy and the server.
21081
21082 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21083 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21084 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21085 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21086 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21087 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21088 solution is to fix the application.
21089
21090 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21091 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21092 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21093 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21094 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21095 external attacks.
21096
21097 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021098 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021099 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021100 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21101 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21102
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021103 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21104 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21105 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021106 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021107 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021108
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021109 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21110 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21111 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21112 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021113 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21114 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21115 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21116 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21117 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021118
21119 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21120 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21121 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21122 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21123
21124 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21125 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21126 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21127 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21128
21129 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21130 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21131 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21132 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21133
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021134The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
21135persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
21136important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21137re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21138
21139 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21140
21141 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21142 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21143 set on a GET request.
21144
21145 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21146 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021147 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021148 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21149
21150 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21151 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21152 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21153
21154 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21155 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21156 already got a cookie.
21157
21158 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21159 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21160 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21161 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21162 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21163
21164 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21165 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21166 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21167
21168 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21169 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21170 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21171
21172 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21173 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21174
21175 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21176 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21177 then advertised in the response.
21178
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211808.6. Non-printable characters
21181-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021182
21183In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21184consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21185converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21186prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21187being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21188escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21189is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21190'}' when logging headers.
21191
21192Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21193issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21194containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21195
21196Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21197the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21198performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21199
21200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212018.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21202---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021203
21204Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21205achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021206section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021207cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21208the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21209the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021210locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021211not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21212user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21213a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21214wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21215
21216 Examples :
21217 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21218 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21219
21220 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21221 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21222
21223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212248.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21225---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021226
21227Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21228proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21229the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21230server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21231
21232Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21233response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021234section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021235
21236It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021237time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21238appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021239are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21240and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21241follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21242request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21243in the logs.
21244
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021245As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21246frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21247an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21248
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021249 Example :
21250 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21251 listen proxy-out
21252 mode http
21253 option httplog
21254 option logasap
21255 log global
21256 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21257
21258 # log the name of the virtual server
21259 capture request header Host len 20
21260
21261 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21262 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21263
21264 # log the beginning of the referrer
21265 capture request header Referer len 20
21266
21267 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21268 capture response header Server len 20
21269
21270 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21271 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21272
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021273 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021274 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21275
21276 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21277 capture response header Via len 20
21278
21279 # log the URL location during a redirection
21280 capture response header Location len 20
21281
21282 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21283 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21284 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21285 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21286 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21287
21288 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21289 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21290 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21291 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021292 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021293
21294 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21295 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21296 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21297 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21298 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021299 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021300
21301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213028.9. Examples of logs
21303---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021304
21305These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21306them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21307reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21308
21309 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21310 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21311 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21312
21313 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21314 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21315
21316 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21317 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21318 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21319
21320 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21321 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21322
21323 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21324 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21325 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21326
21327 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021328 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021329 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21330 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21331
21332 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21333 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21334 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21335
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021336 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21337 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21338 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21339 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21340 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21341 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021342
21343 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021344 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021345
21346 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21347 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21348 Nothing was sent to any server.
21349
21350 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21351 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21352
21353 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21354 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021355 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021356 send a 408 return code to the client.
21357
21358 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21359 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21360
21361 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21362 5 seconds ("c----").
21363
21364 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21365 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021366 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021367
21368 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021369 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021370 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21371 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21372 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21373 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21374 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021375
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021376
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200213779. Supported filters
21378--------------------
21379
21380Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21381accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21382unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21383
21384See also : "filter"
21385
213869.1. Trace
21387----------
21388
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021389filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021390
21391 Arguments:
21392 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21393 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21394
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021395 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021396
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021397 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021398 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21399 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21400 amount of the parsed data.
21401
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021402 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021403
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021404This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21405callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21406information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21407filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21408
21409Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21410tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21411a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21412
21413
214149.2. HTTP compression
21415---------------------
21416
21417filter compression
21418
21419The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21420keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021421when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21422fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21423done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21424explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21425filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21426listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21427order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021428
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021429See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21430 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021431
21432
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200214339.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21434--------------------------------------------
21435
21436filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21437
21438 Arguments :
21439
21440 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21441 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21442 parsed.
21443
21444 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21445 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21446 part must be placed in its own scope.
21447
21448The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21449external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021450streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021451exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21452also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21453
21454SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21455the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21456
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021457For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021458"doc/SPOE.txt".
21459
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100214609.4. Cache
21461----------
21462
21463filter cache <name>
21464
21465 Arguments :
21466
21467 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21468
21469The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21470"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021471cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021472other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21473case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21474is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21475filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021476listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21477order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021478
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021479See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21480 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21481
21482
214839.5. Fcgi-app
21484-------------
21485
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021486filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021487
21488 Arguments :
21489
21490 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21491
21492The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21493request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21494reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21495used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21496implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21497used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21498fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21499used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21500order.
21501
21502See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21503 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21504
21505
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100215069.6. OpenTracing
21507----------------
21508
21509The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21510HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21511of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21512Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21513
21514This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21515
21516The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21517HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21518participates in the work of HAProxy.
21519
21520filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21521
21522 Arguments :
21523
21524 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21525 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21526 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21527 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21528 OpenTracing filters.
21529
21530 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21531 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21532 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21533 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21534 filter must have its own scope defined.
21535
21536More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021537of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021538
21539
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002154010. FastCGI applications
21541-------------------------
21542
21543HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21544feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21545the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21546FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21547servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21548FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21549backend.
21550
21551HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21552application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21553connection.
21554
2155510.1. Setup
21556-----------
21557
2155810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21559--------------------------
21560
21561fcgi-app <name>
21562 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21563 document root must be defined.
21564
21565acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21566 Declare or complete an access list.
21567
21568 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21569 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21570 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21571 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21572 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21573
21574docroot <path>
21575 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21576 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21577 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21578
21579index <script-name>
21580 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21581 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21582 is an optional setting.
21583
21584 Example :
21585 index index.php
21586
21587log-stderr global
21588log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021589 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021590 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21591
21592 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21593 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21594
21595pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21596 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21597 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21598 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21599
21600 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21601 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21602 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21603 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21604
21605 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21606 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21607
21608path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021609 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021610 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21611 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21612 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21613 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21614 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21615 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21616 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021617
21618 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021619 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021620 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21621 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21622 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21623 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021624
21625 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021626 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21627 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021628
21629option get-values
21630no option get-values
21631 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21632
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021633 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021634 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21635
21636 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21637 application will accept.
21638
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021639 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21640 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021641
21642 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021643 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021644 option is disabled.
21645
21646 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21647 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21648 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21649 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21650 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21651 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21652
21653option keep-conn
21654no option keep-conn
21655 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21656 sending a response.
21657
21658 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21659 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21660
21661option max-reqs <reqs>
21662 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21663 accept.
21664
21665 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21666 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21667 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21668 to 1.
21669
21670option mpxs-conns
21671no option mpxs-conns
21672 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21673
21674 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21675 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21676
21677set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21678 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21679 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21680 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21681 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21682
21683 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21684 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21685 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21686
21687 Example :
21688 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21689 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21690
21691 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21692
21693
2169410.1.2. Proxy section
21695---------------------
21696
21697use-fcgi-app <name>
21698 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21699
21700 Arguments :
21701 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21702
21703 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21704 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21705 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21706 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21707 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21708
21709 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21710 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21711 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21712 application are evaluated.
21713
21714
2171510.1.3. Example
21716---------------
21717
21718 frontend front-http
21719 mode http
21720 bind *:80
21721 bind *:
21722
21723 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21724 default_backend back-static
21725
21726 backend back-static
21727 mode http
21728 server www A.B.C.D:80
21729
21730 backend back-dynamic
21731 mode http
21732 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21733 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21734
21735 fcgi-app php-fpm
21736 log-stderr global
21737 option keep-conn
21738
21739 docroot /var/www/my-app
21740 index index.php
21741 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21742
21743
2174410.2. Default parameters
21745------------------------
21746
21747A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21748the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021749script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021750applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21751
21752 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21753 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21754 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21755 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21756 | | |
21757 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21758 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21759 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21760 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21761 | | application. |
21762 | | |
21763 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21764 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21765 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21766 | | |
21767 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21768 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21769 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21770 | | the application's configuration. |
21771 | | |
21772 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21773 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21774 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21775 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21776 | | |
21777 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21778 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21779 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21780 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21781 | | be defined. |
21782 | | |
21783 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21784 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21785 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21786 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21787 | | is not set too. |
21788 | | |
21789 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21790 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21791 | | set. |
21792 | | |
21793 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21794 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21795 | | the request. |
21796 | | |
21797 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21798 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21799 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21800 | | |
21801 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21802 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21803 | | script to process the request. |
21804 | | |
21805 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21806 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21807 | | |
21808 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21809 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21810 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21811 | | |
21812 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21813 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21814 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21815 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21816 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21817 | | |
21818 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21819 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21820 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21821 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21822 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21823 | | side. |
21824 | | |
21825 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21826 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21827 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21828 | | connected to. |
21829 | | |
21830 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21831 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21832 | | |
21833 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21834 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21835 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21836 | | |
21837 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21838
21839
2184010.3. Limitations
21841------------------
21842
21843The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21844way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21845during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21846establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21847application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21848or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21849message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21850these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21851and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21852
21853Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21854request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21855requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21856
21857About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21858into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21859fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21860"http-request" ones.
21861
21862Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21863FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21864processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21865must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21866here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021867
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021868
2186911. Address formats
21870-------------------
21871
21872Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21873address.
21874
21875This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21876The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21877of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21878equivalent is '::'.
21879
21880Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21881is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21882
21883This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21884family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21885
21886Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21887configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21888use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21889'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21890
21891Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21892socket type and the transport method.
21893
21894
2189511.1 Address family prefixes
21896----------------------------
21897
21898'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21899
21900'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21901 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21902 listening.
21903
21904'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21905 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21906 on the statement using this address, a port or
21907 a port range may or must be specified.
21908
21909'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21910 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21911 using this address, a port or a port range
21912 may or must be specified.
21913
21914'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21915 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21916 using this address, a port or a port range
21917 may or must be specified.
21918
21919'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21920 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21921 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21922 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21923 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21924 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21925
21926'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21927 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21928 start by slash '/'.
21929
21930
2193111.2 Socket type prefixes
21932-------------------------
21933
21934Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21935type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21936this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21937This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21938but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21939
21940Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21941instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21942
21943If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21944they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21945report this to the maintainers.
21946
21947'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21948 to "stream"
21949
21950'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21951 to "datagram".
21952
21953
2195411.3 Protocol prefixes
21955----------------------
21956
21957'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21958 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21959 socket type and transport method is forced to
21960 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21961 this address, a port or a port range can or
21962 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21963 of 'stream+ip@'.
21964
21965'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21966 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21967 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21968 statement using this address, a port or port
21969 range can or must be specified.
21970 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21971
21972'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21973 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21974 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21975 statement using this address, a port or port
21976 range can or must be specified.
21977 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21978
21979'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21980 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21981 socket type and transport method is forced to
21982 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
21983 this address, a port or a port range can or
21984 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21985 of 'dgram+ip@'.
21986
21987'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21988 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21989 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21990 the statement using this address, a port or
21991 port range can or must be specified.
21992 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21993
21994'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21995 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21996 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21997 the statement using this address, a port or
21998 port range can or must be specified.
21999 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22000
22001'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22002 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22003 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22004
22005'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22006 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22007 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22008
22009In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22010QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22011
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022012/*
22013 * Local variables:
22014 * fill-column: 79
22015 * End:
22016 */